jtag/xds110: switch to command 'adapter serial'
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, kitprog, presto, vsllink, xds110.
2375 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2376 hla, jlink, st-link.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @section Interface Drivers
2380
2381 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2382 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2383 available at run time.
2384
2385 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2386 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2387 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2388 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2389
2390 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2391 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2392 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2396 Displays status of RTCK option.
2397 Optionally sets that option first.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2402 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2403 This has one driver-specific command:
2404
2405 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2406 Logs some status
2407 @end deffn
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2411 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2412 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2413 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2414 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2415 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2419 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2420 or v2 (USB bulk).
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2423 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2424 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2425 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2426 @example
2427 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2428 @end example
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2432 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2433
2434 @itemize @minus
2435 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2436 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2437 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2438 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2439 @end itemize
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2443 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2444 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2445 interface string or for user class interface.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2516 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2517 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2521 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2522 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2523 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2524 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2525 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2526 and initially asserted reset signals.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2530 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2531 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2532 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2533 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2534 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2535 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2536 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2537 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2538 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2539 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2540
2541 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2542 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2543 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2544 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2545 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2546 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2547
2548 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2549 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2550 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2551 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2552 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2553 are always driven by the FTDI.
2554
2555 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2556 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2557 @var{name}.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2561 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2562 @itemize @minus
2563 @item @option{0}, drive low
2564 @item @option{1}, drive high
2565 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2566 @end itemize
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2570 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2574 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2575
2576 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2577 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2578 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2579 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2582 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2583 @end itemize
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2587 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2588
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2592 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2593 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2594 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2595
2596 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2597 @itemize @minus
2598 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2599 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2600 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2601 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2602 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2603 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2604 @end itemize
2605
2606 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2607 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2608 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2609 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2610 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2611 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2612 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2613 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2614
2615 FT232R
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item bit 7 - RI
2618 @item bit 6 - DCD
2619 @item bit 5 - DSR
2620 @item bit 4 - DTR
2621 @item bit 3 - CTS
2622 @item bit 2 - RTS
2623 @item bit 1 - RXD
2624 @item bit 0 - TXD
2625 @end itemize
2626
2627 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2628 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2631 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2632 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2636 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2637 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2641 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2645 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2649 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2653 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2657 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2661 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2665 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2666 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2667 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2668 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2669 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2670 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2671 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2672 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2673 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2679 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2680 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2681 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2682
2683 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2684 processors which are being simulated.
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2687 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2688 sockets instead of TCP.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2692 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2693 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2697 something like:
2698
2699 @example
2700 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2701 remote_bitbang port 3335
2702 remote_bitbang host foobar
2703 @end example
2704
2705 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2706 named mysocket:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 0
2711 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2712 @end example
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2716 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2717 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2718 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2721 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2722 default values are used.
2723 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2724 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2725 @example
2726 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2727 @end example
2728 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2729 @example
2730 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2735 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2736 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2737 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2738 target board.
2739
2740 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2741 @example
2742 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2743 reset_config srst_only
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2748 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2749 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2750 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2754 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2755 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2761 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2762 This has one driver-specific command:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2765 Display either the address of the I/O port
2766 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2767 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2768 This is a write-once setting.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @end deffn
2771
2772 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2773 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2774 transports.
2775
2776 @quotation Compatibility Note
2777 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2778 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2779 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2780 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2781 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2782 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2783 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2784 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2785 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2786 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2787 @end quotation
2788
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2790 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2791 states.
2792 @end deffn
2793 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2794 Display free device internal memory.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2797 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2798 command version.
2799 @end deffn
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2801 Display the device configuration.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2804 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2805 power state.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2808 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2811 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2812 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2813 IP configuration.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2816 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2817 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2820 Reset the current configuration.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2823 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2826 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2827 pairs.
2828
2829 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2830 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2831 @example
2832 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2836 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2837 pairs.
2838
2839 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2842 77a90000
2843 @end example
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2846 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2847 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2848 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2849 the serial number instead, if possible.
2850
2851 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2854 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2855 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2856
2857 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2858 @end deffn
2859 @end deffn
2860
2861 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2862 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2863 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2864 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2865 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2866 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2867 configuration script.
2868
2869 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2870 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2871 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2872 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2873 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2874
2875 Known limitations:
2876 @itemize @bullet
2877 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2878 and 2.7 MHz.
2879 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2880 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2881 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2882 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2883 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2884 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2885 communications with the target.
2886 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2887 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2888 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2889 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2890 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2891 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2892 @end itemize
2893
2894 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2895 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2896 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2900 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2901 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2902 target as a side-effect.
2903 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2907 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2908 version, and target voltage.
2909 @end deffn
2910 @end deffn
2911
2912 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2913 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2914 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2915 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2916 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2917
2918 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2919 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2920 This is a write-once setting.
2921 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2922
2923 @itemize @minus
2924 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2925 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2926 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2927 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2928 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2929 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2930 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2931 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2932 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2933 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2934 some versions of
2935 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2936 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2937 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2938 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2939 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2940 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2941 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2942 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2943 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2944 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2945 @end itemize
2946 @end deffn
2947
2948 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2949 Display either the address of the I/O port
2950 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2951 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2952 This is a write-once setting.
2953
2954 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2955 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2956 you may encounter a problem.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2960 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2961 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2962 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2963 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2964 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2965
2966 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2967 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2968 @quotation Tip
2969 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2970 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2971 @example
2972 > parport toggling_time 1000
2973 > adapter speed 500
2974 @end example
2975 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2976 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2977 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2978 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2979 large set of samples.
2980 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2981 @example
2982 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2983 @end example
2984 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2985 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2986
2987 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2988 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2989 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2990 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2991 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2992 be conservative.
2993 @end quotation
2994 @end deffn
2995
2996 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2997 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2998 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2999 @end deffn
3000
3001 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3002 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3003
3004 @example
3005 adapter driver parport
3006 parport port 0x278
3007 parport cable wiggler
3008 @end example
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3012 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3013 @end deffn
3014
3015 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3016 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3017 @end deffn
3018
3019 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3020 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3021 @end deffn
3022
3023 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3024 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3025
3026 @quotation Note
3027 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3028 which are not currently documented here.
3029 @end quotation
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @anchor{hla_interface}
3033 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3034 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3035 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3036 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3037
3038 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3039 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3040 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3041 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3042 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3043 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3044
3045 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3046 Currently Not Supported.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3050 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3051 @end deffn
3052
3053 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3054 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3058 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3062 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3063 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3064
3065 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3066 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3067 ST-LINK server software module}.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3071 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3072 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3073 @end deffn
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3078 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3079 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3080 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3081
3082 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3083 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3084 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3085 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3086
3087 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3088 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3089
3090 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3091 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3092 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3093
3094 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3095 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3096 ST-LINK server software module}.
3097
3098 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3099 @end deffn
3100
3101 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3102 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3103 @end deffn
3104
3105 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3106 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3110 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3111 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3112
3113 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3114 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3115 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3116 the target's supply voltage.
3117 @example
3118 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3119 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3120 @end example
3121 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3122 @example
3123 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3124 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3125 3.24891518738
3126 @end example
3127 @end deffn
3128 @end deffn
3129
3130 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3131 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3135 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3139 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3140 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3141 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3142 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3143
3144 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3145 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3146 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3147 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3151 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3152 version).
3153 @end deffn
3154 @end deffn
3155
3156 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3157 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3158 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3159 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3160 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3161
3162 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3165 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3166
3167 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3168 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3169
3170 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3171
3172 @end deffn
3173 @end deffn
3174
3175 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3176 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3177 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3178
3179 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3180 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3181 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3182 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3183 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3184 configuration on exit.
3185
3186 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3187
3188 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3189 pinout.
3190
3191 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3192 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3193 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3194 individually.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3198 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3199 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3200 @end deffn
3201
3202 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3203 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3204 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3205 @end deffn
3206
3207 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3208 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3209 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3213 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3214 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3215 @end deffn
3216
3217 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3218 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3219 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3223 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3224 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3225 @end deffn
3226
3227 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3228 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3229 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3230 @end deffn
3231
3232 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3233 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3234 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3235 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3239 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3243 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3244 @end deffn
3245
3246 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3247 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3248 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3252 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3253 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3254 list can be found in the
3255 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3261 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3262 of the one which is most popular.
3263
3264 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3265
3266 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3267 pinout.
3268
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271
3272 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3273 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3274 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3275
3276 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3281 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3282 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3283
3284 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287
3288 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3289 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3290 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3291
3292 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3293 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3294 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3295
3296 @itemize @minus
3297 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3298 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3299 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3300 @end itemize
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3304 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3305 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3306 @end deffn
3307 @end deffn
3308
3309
3310 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3311 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3312 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3313 DPI server interface.
3314
3315 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3316 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3320 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3321 @end deffn
3322 @end deffn
3323
3324
3325 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3326
3327 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3328 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3329
3330 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3331 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3332
3333 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3334 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3335 @example
3336 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3337 @end example
3338 @end deffn
3339
3340 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3341 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3342 @example
3343 buspirate speed normal
3344 @end example
3345 @end deffn
3346
3347 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3348 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3349 @itemize @minus
3350 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3351 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3352 @end itemize
3353 For example:
3354 @example
3355 buspirate mode normal
3356 @end example
3357 @end deffn
3358
3359 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3360 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3361 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3362 For example:
3363 @example
3364 buspirate pullup 0
3365 @end example
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3369 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3370 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3371 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3372 @example
3373 buspirate vreg 0
3374 @end example
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3378 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3379 @end deffn
3380 @example
3381 buspirate led 1
3382 @end example
3383
3384 @end deffn
3385
3386
3387 @section Transport Configuration
3388 @cindex Transport
3389 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3390 and the debug adapter you are using,
3391 several transports may be available to
3392 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3393 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3394 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3395 version of OpenOCD.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3399 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3400
3401 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3402 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3403 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3404 adapter's driver).
3405
3406 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3407 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3408 supported by the debug adapter.
3409
3410 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3411 transport, if any.
3412 @end deffn
3413
3414 @subsection JTAG Transport
3415 @cindex JTAG
3416 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3417 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3418 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3419 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3420 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3421 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3422
3423 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3424 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3425 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3426 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3427 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3428
3429 @subsection SWD Transport
3430 @cindex SWD
3431 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3432 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3433 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3434 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3435 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3436 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3437 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3438
3439 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3440 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3441 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3442 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3443 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3444
3445 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3446 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3447 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3448 expected to change.
3449 @end deffn
3450
3451 @subsection SPI Transport
3452 @cindex SPI
3453 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3454 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3455 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3456 solution for flash programming.
3457
3458 @anchor{swimtransport}
3459 @subsection SWIM Transport
3460 @cindex SWIM
3461 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3462 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3463 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3464 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3465
3466 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3467
3468 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3469
3470 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3471 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3472 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3473 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3474 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3475
3476 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3477 @section JTAG Speed
3478 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3479 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3480 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3481 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3482 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3483 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3484 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3485 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3486 power management software that may be active.
3487
3488 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3489 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3490 target event handler.
3491 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3492 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3493 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3494 sets up those clocks).
3495 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3496 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3497 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3498 in the target config file.
3499 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3500 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3501 config file instead.
3502 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3503 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3504 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3505
3506 @example
3507 jtag_rclk 3000
3508 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3509 @end example
3510
3511 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3512 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3513 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3514 may not be the fastest solution.
3515
3516 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3517 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3518 which support adaptive clocking.
3519
3520 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3521 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3522 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3523 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3524 than the speed specified.
3525
3526 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3527 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3528 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3529 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3530
3531 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3532 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3533 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3534 JTAG clocking after setup.
3535 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3536 If the interface device can not
3537 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3538 @end deffn
3539
3540 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3541 @cindex adaptive clocking
3542 @cindex RTCK
3543 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3544 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3545 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3546 @example
3547 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3548 jtag_rclk 3000
3549 @end example
3550 @end defun
3551
3552 @node Reset Configuration
3553 @chapter Reset Configuration
3554 @cindex Reset Configuration
3555
3556 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3557 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3558 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3559 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3560 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3561 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3562 Please see the various board files for examples.
3563
3564 @quotation Note
3565 To maintainers and integrators:
3566 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3567 Normally the board configuration file
3568 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3569 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3570
3571 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3572 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3573 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3574 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3575 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3576 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3577 @end quotation
3578
3579 @section Types of Reset
3580
3581 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3582 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3583 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3584
3585 @itemize @bullet
3586 @item
3587 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3588 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3589 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3590 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3591 @item
3592 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3593 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3594 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3595 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3596 @item
3597 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3598 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3599 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3600 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3601 @item
3602 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3603 several other types of reset.
3604 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3605 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3606 There may be individual module resets.
3607 @end itemize
3608
3609 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3610 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3611 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3612 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3613 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3614 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3615 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3616 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3617 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3618
3619 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3620 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3621
3622 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3623 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3624 common issues are:
3625
3626 @itemize @bullet
3627
3628 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3629 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3630 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3631 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3632 when either of those signals is not connected.
3633 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3634 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3635 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3636 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3637
3638 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3639 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3640 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3641 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3642
3643 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3644 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3645 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3646 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3647 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3648 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3649 hardware debouncing.
3650 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3651 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3652
3653 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3654 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3655 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3656 to use push/pull output drivers.
3657 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3658 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3659 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3660 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3661
3662 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3663 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3664 issues (not limited to errata).
3665 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3666 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3667 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3668 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3669 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3670 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3671 @end itemize
3672
3673 There can also be other issues.
3674 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3675 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3676 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3677 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3678 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3679 Agreement (NDA).
3680
3681 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3682 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3683 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3684
3685 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3686 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3687
3688 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3689
3690 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3691 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3692 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3693 allowing it to be deasserted.
3694 @end deffn
3695
3696 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3697 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3698 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3699 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3700 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3701 @end deffn
3702
3703 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3704 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3705 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3706 allowing it to be deasserted.
3707 @end deffn
3708
3709 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3710 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3711 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3712 @end deffn
3713
3714 @anchor{reset_config}
3715 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3716 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3717 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3718 configuration scripts.
3719
3720 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3721 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3722 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3723 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3724 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3725 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3726 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3727 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3728
3729 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3730 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3731 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3732 -- may be specified at a time.
3733 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3734 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3735 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3736 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3737 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3738
3739 @itemize
3740 @item
3741 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3742 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3743 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3744 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3745 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3746
3747 @quotation Tip
3748 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3749 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3750 @end quotation
3751
3752 @item
3753 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3754 signal implementations.
3755 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3756 indicating everything behaves normally.
3757 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3758 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3759 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3760 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3761 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3762 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3763 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3764
3765 @item
3766 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3767 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3768 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3769 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3770 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3771 while SRST is asserted.
3772 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3773 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3774
3775 @item
3776 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3777 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3778 is required to use this option.
3779 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3780 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3781 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3782 be asserted before any target connection.
3783 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3784 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3785 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3786 @end itemize
3787
3788 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3789 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3790 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3791 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3792 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3793
3794 @itemize
3795 @item
3796 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3797 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3798 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3799 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3800
3801 @item
3802 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3803 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3804 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3805 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3806 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3807 @end itemize
3808 @end deffn
3809
3810 @section Custom Reset Handling
3811 @cindex events
3812
3813 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3814 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3815 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3816 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3817 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3818 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3819
3820 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3821 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3822 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3823 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3824 want to reset everything at once.
3825
3826 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3827 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3828 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3829 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3830 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3831 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3832 needs special attention.
3833
3834 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3835 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3836 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3837 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3838 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3839 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3840 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3841 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3842 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3843
3844 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3845 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3846 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3847 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3848 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3849
3850 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3851 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3852 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3853 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3854 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3855 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3856 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3857 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3858 or potentially some other value.
3859
3860 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3861 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3862 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3863 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3864 (or their associated targets)
3865 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3866
3867 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3868 they return.
3869 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3870 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3871 @end deffn
3872
3873 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3874 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3875 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3876 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3877 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3878 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3879 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3880 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3881 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3882 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3883 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3884 @end deffn
3885
3886 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3887 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3888 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3889 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3890 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3891 @end deffn
3892
3893
3894 @node TAP Declaration
3895 @chapter TAP Declaration
3896 @cindex TAP declaration
3897 @cindex TAP configuration
3898
3899 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3900 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3901
3902 @itemize @bullet
3903 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3904 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3905 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3906 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3907 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3908 start running that code.
3909 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3910 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3911 and missing connections.
3912 @end itemize
3913
3914 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3915 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3916 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3917 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3918 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3919
3920 @section Scan Chains
3921 @cindex scan chain
3922
3923 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3924 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3925 They also need to be added to
3926 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3927 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3928 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3929 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3930 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3931 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3932 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3933 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3934
3935 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3936 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3937 command, presented in the next chapter.
3938 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3939 debugging targets.)
3940 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3941
3942 @verbatim
3943 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3944 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3945 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3946 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3947 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3948 @end verbatim
3949
3950 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3951 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3952 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3953 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3954 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3955 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3956 until they are told to do so.
3957
3958 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3959 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3960 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3961 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3962
3963 @example
3964 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3965 @end example
3966
3967 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3968 by a given chip.
3969 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3970 and so forth.
3971 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3972 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3973 both inside a single chip and between them.
3974 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3975
3976 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3977 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3978 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3979 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3980 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3981 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3982 includes commands something like this:
3983
3984 @example
3985 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3986 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3987 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3988 @end example
3989
3990 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3991 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3992 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3993
3994 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3995 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3996 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3997 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3998 @example
3999 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4000 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4001 @}
4002 @end example
4003 @end deffn
4004
4005 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4006 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4007 and their status.
4008 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4009 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4010 but systems with a JTAG router can
4011 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4012 @end deffn
4013
4014 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4015 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4016
4017 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4018 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4019
4020 @section TAP Names
4021 @cindex dotted name
4022
4023 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4024 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4025 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4026 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4027 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4028 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4029 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4030 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4031
4032 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4033 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4034 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4035
4036 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4037
4038 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4039 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4040 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4041
4042 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4043 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4044 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4045 overridable.
4046
4047 @cindex TAP naming convention
4048 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4049 and should follow this convention:
4050
4051 @itemize @bullet
4052 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4053 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4054 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4055 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4056 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4057 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4058 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4059 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4060 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4061 with a single TAP;
4062 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4063 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4064 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4065 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4066 @end itemize
4067
4068 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4069
4070 @itemize @bullet
4071 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4072 @*The length in bits of the
4073 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4074 @end itemize
4075
4076 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4077
4078 @itemize @bullet
4079 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4080 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4081 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4082 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4083 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4084 (the TAP is linked in).
4085 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4086 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4087 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4088 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4089 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4090 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4091 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4092 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4093 values that were found but not included in the list.
4094
4095 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4096 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4097 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4098 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4099 hardware to find these values.
4100 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4101 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4102 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4103 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4104 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4105 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4106 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4107 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4108 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4109 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4110 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4111 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4112 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4113 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4114 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4115 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4116 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4117 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4118 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4119 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4120 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4121 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4122 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4123 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4124 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4125 @end itemize
4126 @end deffn
4127
4128 @section Other TAP commands
4129
4130 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4131 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4132 @end deffn
4133
4134 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4135 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4136 At this writing this TAP attribute
4137 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4138 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4139 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4140 See the next section for information about the available events.
4141
4142 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4143 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4144 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4145 @end deffn
4146
4147 @section TAP Events
4148 @cindex events
4149 @cindex TAP events
4150
4151 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4152 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4153 The other applies to debugger targets,
4154 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4155
4156 The TAP events currently defined are:
4157
4158 @itemize @bullet
4159 @item @b{post-reset}
4160 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4161 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4162 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4163 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4164 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4165
4166 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4167 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4168 of any particular target.
4169 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4170 @item @b{setup}
4171 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4172 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4173 @item @b{tap-disable}
4174 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4175 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4176 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4177 @item @b{tap-enable}
4178 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4179 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4180 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4181 @end itemize
4182
4183 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4184 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4185 contents to be accurate), you might:
4186
4187 @example
4188 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4189 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4190 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4191 @}
4192 @end example
4193
4194
4195 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4196 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4197 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4198 @cindex jrc
4199
4200 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4201 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4202 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4203 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4204 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4205
4206 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4207 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4208 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4209 be visible.
4210 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4211 ignores, such as:
4212
4213 @itemize
4214 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4215 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4216 TAPs receive new instructions.
4217 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4218 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4219 @end itemize
4220
4221 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4222 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4223 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4224 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4225
4226 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4227 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4228
4229 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4230 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4231 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4232 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4233 should define TAP event handlers using
4234 code that looks something like this:
4235
4236 @example
4237 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4238 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4239 @}
4240 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4241 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4242 @}
4243 @end example
4244
4245 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4246
4247 @example
4248 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4249 @end example
4250
4251 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4252 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4253 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4254 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4255
4256 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4257 If necessary, disables the tap
4258 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4259 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4260 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4261 and "0" if it is disabled.
4262 @end deffn
4263
4264 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4265 If necessary, enables the tap
4266 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4267 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4268 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4269 and "0" if it is disabled.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4273 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4274 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4275 and "0" if it is disabled.
4276
4277 @quotation Note
4278 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4279 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4280 @end quotation
4281 @end deffn
4282
4283 @anchor{autoprobing}
4284 @section Autoprobing
4285 @cindex autoprobe
4286 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4287
4288 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4289 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4290 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4291 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4292
4293 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4294 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4295 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4296 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4297 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4298 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4299 right when they come out of reset).
4300
4301 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4302
4303 @example
4304 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4305 reset_config trst_and_srst
4306 jtag_rclk 8
4307 @end example
4308
4309 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4310 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4311
4312 @enumerate
4313 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4314 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4315 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4316 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4317 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4318 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4319 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4320 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4321 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4322 that is discovered.
4323 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4324 register, it will report it.
4325 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4326 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4327 @end enumerate
4328
4329 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4330 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4331 that's a bit more complex:
4332
4333 @example
4334 clock speed 8 kHz
4335 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4336 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4337 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4338 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4339 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4340 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4341 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4342 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4343 @end example
4344
4345 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4346 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4347 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4348 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4349 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4350 and so forth.
4351
4352 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4353 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4354 @cindex DAP declaration
4355
4356 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4357 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4358 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4359 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4360 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4361
4362 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4363
4364 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4365 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4366 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4367 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4368 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4369
4370 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4371
4372 @itemize @bullet
4373 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4374 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4375 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4376 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4377 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4378
4379 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4380 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4381 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4382 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4383 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4384 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4385
4386 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4387 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4388 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4389 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4390 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4391 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4392 @end itemize
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4396 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4397 for TCL scripting.
4398 @end deffn
4399
4400 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4401 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4402 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4403 @end deffn
4404
4405 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4406 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4407 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4408 initialization, too.
4409 @end deffn
4410
4411 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4414 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4415 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4419 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4420 @end deffn
4421
4422 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4423 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4424 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4425 or set a new value @var{value}.
4426 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4430 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4431 @end deffn
4432
4433 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4434 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4435 value @var{value}.
4436
4437 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4438 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4439 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4440
4441 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4442 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4443 @end deffn
4444
4445 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4446 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4447 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4448 @end deffn
4449
4450 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4451 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4452 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4453 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4454 @end deffn
4455
4456 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4457 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4458
4459 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4460 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4461 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4462 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4463 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4464 for details.
4465
4466 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4467 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4468 the pattern:
4469 @example
4470 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4471 @end example
4472
4473 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4474 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4475 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4476 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4477 @example
4478 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4479 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4480 @end example
4481
4482 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4483 @example
4484 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4485 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4486 @end example
4487
4488 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4489 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4490
4491 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4492 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4493 example with a proper dap name:
4494 @example
4495 xxx.dap apcsw default
4496 @end example
4497 @end deffn
4498
4499 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4500 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4501 Disabled by default
4502 @end deffn
4503
4504
4505 @node CPU Configuration
4506 @chapter CPU Configuration
4507 @cindex GDB target
4508
4509 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4510 You can also access these targets without GDB
4511 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4512 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4513 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4514 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4515
4516 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4517 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4518
4519 @section Target List
4520 @cindex target, current
4521 @cindex target, list
4522
4523 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4524 where each member has a name.
4525 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4526 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4527 (plural!) command.
4528 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4529 look like with more than one:
4530 @verbatim
4531 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4532 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4533 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4534 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4535 @end verbatim
4536
4537 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4538 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4539 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4540 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4541 space seen by that current target.
4542 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4543 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4544 are examples; and there are many more.
4545
4546 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4547
4548 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4549 Returns the name of the current target.
4550 @end deffn
4551
4552 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4553 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4554 @example
4555 foreach t [target names] @{
4556 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4557 @}
4558 @end example
4559 @end deffn
4560
4561 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4562 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4563
4564 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4565 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4566 command names are singular.}
4567
4568 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4569 targets in a user friendly form.
4570
4571 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4572 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4573 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @section Target CPU Types
4577 @cindex target type
4578 @cindex CPU type
4579
4580 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4581 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4582 when calling @command{target create}.
4583 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4584 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4585 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4586 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4587 what core-specific commands may be available
4588 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4589 and more.
4590
4591 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4592 since there's a command to list them.
4593
4594 @anchor{targettypes}
4595 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4596 Lists all supported target types.
4597 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4598
4599 @itemize @bullet
4600 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4601 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4602 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4603 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4604 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4605 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4606 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4607 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4608 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4609 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4610 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4611 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4612 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4613 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4614 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4615 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4616 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4617 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4618 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4619 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4620 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4621 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4622 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4623 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4624 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4625 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4626 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4627 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4628 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4629 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4630 support for new CPUs.
4631 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4632 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4633 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4634 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4635 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4636 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4637 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4638 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4639 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4640 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4641 @itemize @minus
4642 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4643 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4644 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4645 @end itemize
4646 And two debug interfaces cores:
4647 @itemize @minus
4648 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4649 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4650 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4651 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4652 @end itemize
4653 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4654 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4655 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4656 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4657 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4658 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4659 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4660 @end itemize
4661 @end deffn
4662
4663 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4664 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4665 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4666 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4667 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4668 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4669 reflect design generations;
4670 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4671 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4672
4673 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4674 @section Target Configuration
4675
4676 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4677 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4678 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4679 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4680 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4681
4682 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4683 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4684 optional parts.
4685 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4686 command, created as part of target creation.
4687
4688 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4689 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4690 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4691 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4692 to be much more board-specific.
4693 The key steps you use might look something like this
4694
4695 @example
4696 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4697 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4698 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4699 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4700 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4701 @end example
4702
4703 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4704 on-chip SRAM.
4705 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4706 writes to target memory;
4707 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4708 GDB memory checksumming;
4709 and more.
4710
4711 @quotation Warning
4712 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4713 inaccessible when application code
4714 (such as an operating system)
4715 enables or disables the MMU.
4716 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4717 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4718 easy access to other addresses needed.
4719 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4720 @end quotation
4721
4722 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4723 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4724 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4725 controllers.
4726 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4727 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4728 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4729
4730 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4731 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4732 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4733 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4734 purposes including additional configuration.
4735
4736 @itemize @bullet
4737 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4738 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4739 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4740 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4741
4742 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4743 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4744 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4745 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4746 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4747 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4748 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4749
4750 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4751 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4752 @end itemize
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4756 The options accepted by this command may also be
4757 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4758 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4759 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4760
4761 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4762 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4763 and changing its endianness.
4764
4765 @itemize @bullet
4766
4767 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4768 used to access this target.
4769
4770 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4771 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4772 create and manage DAP instances.
4773
4774 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4775 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4776
4777 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4778 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4779 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4780 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4781 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4782 same event name assigns only one handler.
4783
4784 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4785 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4786
4787 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4788 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4789 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4790 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4791 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4792 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4793 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4794
4795 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4796 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4797 or virtual address is being used.
4798
4799 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4800 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4801
4802 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4803 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4804 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4805 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4806 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4807
4808 @anchor{rtostype}
4809 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4810 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4811 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4812 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4813 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4814 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4815
4816 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4817 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4818 access the target for debugging.
4819
4820 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4821 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4822 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4823 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4824
4825 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4826 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4827 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4828 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4829 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4830
4831 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4832 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4833 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4834 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4835 command @command{gdb_port}.
4836 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4837
4838 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4839 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4840 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4841 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4842 @end itemize
4843 @end deffn
4844
4845 @section Other $target_name Commands
4846 @cindex object command
4847
4848 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4849 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4850
4851 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4852 Once a button is created a button
4853 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4854 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4855 configure it like this:
4856
4857 @example
4858 # Create
4859 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4860 # Modify
4861 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4862 # Query
4863 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4864 # Report
4865 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4866 @end example
4867
4868 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4869 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4870
4871 @example
4872 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4873 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4874 @end example
4875
4876 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4877
4878 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4879 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4880 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4881 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4882 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4883 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4884 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4885 They are not otherwise documented here.
4886 @end deffn
4887
4888 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4889 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4890 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4891 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4892 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4893 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4894 the target side uses raw memory.
4895
4896 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4897 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4898 The script orientation comes from working with data
4899 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4900 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4901 and neither store nor return those values.
4902
4903 @itemize
4904 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4905 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4906 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4907 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4908 @end itemize
4909 @end deffn
4910
4911 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4912 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4913 @command{$target_name configure}
4914 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4915 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4916 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4917 There are a few special cases:
4918
4919 @itemize @bullet
4920 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4921 event named @var{event_name}.
4922 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4923 two parameters.
4924 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4925 This is a special case because this is set using
4926 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4927 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4928 @end itemize
4929
4930 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4931 all the targets you might use something like this:
4932
4933 @example
4934 foreach name [target names] @{
4935 set y [$name cget -endian]
4936 set z [$name cget -type]
4937 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4938 $x $name $y $z]
4939 @}
4940 @end example
4941 @end deffn
4942
4943 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4944 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4945 Displays the current target state:
4946 @code{debug-running},
4947 @code{halted},
4948 @code{reset},
4949 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4950 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4954 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4955 currently associated with this target.
4956 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4960 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4961 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4962 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4963 @end deffn
4964
4965 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4966 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4967 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4968 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4969 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4970 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4971 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4972 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4973 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4974 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4975 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4976 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4977 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4978 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4979 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4980 @end deffn
4981
4982 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4983 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4984 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4985 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4986 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4987 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4988 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4989 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4990 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4991 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4992 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4993 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4994 @end deffn
4995
4996 @anchor{targetevents}
4997 @section Target Events
4998 @cindex target events
4999 @cindex events
5000 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5001 For example:
5002 @itemize @bullet
5003 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5004 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5005 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5006 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5007 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5008 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5009 to set up system clocks or
5010 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5011 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5012 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5013 @end itemize
5014
5015 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5016 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5017 @command{target create ... -event}.
5018
5019 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5020 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5021 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5022
5023 @example
5024 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5025 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5026 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5027 @}
5028 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5029 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5030 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5031 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5032 @}
5033 @end example
5034
5035 The following target events are defined:
5036
5037 @itemize @bullet
5038 @item @b{debug-halted}
5039 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5040 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5041 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5042 @item @b{early-halted}
5043 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5044 @item @b{examine-start}
5045 @* Before target examine is called.
5046 @item @b{examine-end}
5047 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5048 @item @b{examine-fail}
5049 @* After target examine fails.
5050 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5051 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5052 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5053 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5054 connect GDB to running target.
5055 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5056 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5057 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5058 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5059 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5060 is in RAM or read only memory.
5061 Default is @code{halt}
5062 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5063 @* When GDB disconnects
5064 @item @b{gdb-end}
5065 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5066 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5067 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5068 @code{reset init})
5069 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5070 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5071 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5072 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5073 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5074 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5075 @item @b{gdb-start}
5076 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5077 @item @b{halted}
5078 @* The target has halted
5079 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5080 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5081 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5082 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5083 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5084 @item @b{reset-assert}
5085 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5086 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5087 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5088 it instead of asserting SRST.
5089 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5090 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5091 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5092 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5093 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5094 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5095 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5096 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5097 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5098 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5099 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5100 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5101 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5102 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5103 released on the scan chain.
5104 @item @b{reset-end}
5105 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5106 @item @b{reset-init}
5107 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5108 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5109
5110 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5111 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5112 multiplexing, and so on.
5113 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5114 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5115 @item @b{reset-start}
5116 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5117 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5118
5119 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5120 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5121 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5122 @item @b{resume-start}
5123 @* Before any target is resumed
5124 @item @b{resume-end}
5125 @* After all targets have resumed
5126 @item @b{resumed}
5127 @* Target has resumed
5128 @item @b{step-start}
5129 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5130 @item @b{step-end}
5131 @* After single-step has completed
5132 @item @b{trace-config}
5133 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5134 @end itemize
5135
5136 @quotation Note
5137 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5138 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5139 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5140 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5141 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5142 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5143 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5144 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5145 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5146 check if the core has changed status.
5147 @end quotation
5148
5149 @node Flash Commands
5150 @chapter Flash Commands
5151
5152 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5153 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5154 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5155 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5156 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5157 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5158 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5159 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5160 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5161
5162 Flash Steps:
5163 @enumerate
5164 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5165 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5166 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5167 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5168 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5169 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5170 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5171 @item GDB Flashing
5172 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5173 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5174 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5175 @end enumerate
5176
5177 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5178 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5179 so that it can't boot.
5180 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5181 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5182
5183 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5184 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5185 @cindex flash configuration
5186
5187 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5188 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5189 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5190 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5191 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5192 see the driver-specific documentation.
5193
5194 @itemize @bullet
5195 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5196 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5197 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5198 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5199 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5200 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5201 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5202 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5203 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5204 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5205 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5206 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5207 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5208 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5209 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5210 commands to the flash controller.
5211 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5212 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5213 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5214 for more information.
5215 @end itemize
5216 @quotation Note
5217 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5218 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5219 @end quotation
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5223 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5224 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5225 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5226 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5227 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5231 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5232 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5233 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5237 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5238 depends on the flash type.
5239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5240 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5241 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5242 but most don't bother.
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5246
5247 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5248 begins.
5249
5250 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5251 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5252 until the programming session is finished.
5253
5254 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5255 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5256
5257 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5258
5259 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5260 @cindex flash erasing
5261 @cindex flash reading
5262 @cindex flash writing
5263 @cindex flash programming
5264 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5265
5266 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5267 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5268 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5269 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5270 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5271
5272 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5273 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5274 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5275 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5276 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5277
5278 @quotation Note
5279 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5280 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5281 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5282 back to a flash bank.
5283 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5284 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5285 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5286 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5287 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5288 @end quotation
5289
5290 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5291 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5292 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5293 disabled first.
5294 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5295 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5296 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5297
5298 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5299 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5300 up to and including @var{last}.
5301 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5302 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5303 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5305 @end deffn
5306
5307 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5308 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5309 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5310 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5311 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5312 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5313 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5314 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5315 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5316 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5317 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5318 before erase starts.
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5322 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5323 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5324 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5325 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5326 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5327 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5328 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5329 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5330 before issuing this command.
5331 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5332 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5333 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5334 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5335 @end deffn
5336 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5337
5338 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5339 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5340 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5341 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5342 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5343 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5344 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5345 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5346 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5347 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5348 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5352 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5353 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5354 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5359 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5360 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5361 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5362 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5367 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5368 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5369 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5374 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5375 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5376 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5377 to the base address for each section in the image.
5378 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5379 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5380 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5381 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5382 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5383 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5384 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5385 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5386 each image section.
5387
5388 @quotation Warning
5389 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5390 data you want to preserve.
5391 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5392 sections might be erased with no notice.
5393 @itemize
5394 @item
5395 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5396 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5397 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5398 @item
5399 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5400 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5401 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5402 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5403 @end itemize
5404 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5405 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5406 @end quotation
5407
5408 @end deffn
5409
5410 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5411 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5412 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5413 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5414 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5415 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5416 ordinary memory reads.
5417 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5418 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5419 check for successful programming.
5420 @end deffn
5421
5422 @section Other Flash commands
5423 @cindex flash protection
5424
5425 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5426 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5427 and display that status.
5428 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5429 @end deffn
5430
5431 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5432 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5433 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5434
5435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5436 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5437 and possibly stale information.
5438 @end deffn
5439
5440 @anchor{flashprotect}
5441 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5442 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5443 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5444 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5445 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5446 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5447 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5448 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5449 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5450 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5454 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5455 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5456 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @anchor{program}
5460 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5461 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5462 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5463 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5467 @section Flash Driver List
5468 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5469 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5470 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5471
5472 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5473 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5474 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5475
5476 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5477
5478 @itemize
5479 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5480 @end itemize
5481
5482 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5483 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5484 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5485 @example
5486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5487 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5488 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5489 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5490 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5491 @end example
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @subsection External Flash
5495
5496 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5497 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5498 @cindex CFI
5499 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5500 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5501 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5502 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5503 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5504 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5505 configure a bus and its timings), or
5506 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5507 on the flash chip.
5508 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5509 speed up operation.
5510
5511 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5512
5513 @itemize
5514 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5515 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5516 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5517 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5518 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5519 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5520 @end itemize
5521
5522 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5523 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5524
5525 @example
5526 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5527 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5528 @end example
5529
5530 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5531 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5532 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5533
5534 @example
5535 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5536 @end example
5537
5538 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5539 @end deffn
5540
5541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5542 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5543 @cindex SPI
5544 @cindex jtagspi
5545 @cindex bscan_spi
5546 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5547 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5548 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5549 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5550 accessed through JTAG.
5551
5552 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5553 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5554 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5555 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5556 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5557 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5558
5559 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5560 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5561 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5562 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5563 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5564 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5565 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5566 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5567
5568 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5569 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5570 command, see below.
5571
5572 @itemize
5573 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5574 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5575 @var{USER1} instruction.
5576 @end itemize
5577
5578 @example
5579 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5580 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5581 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5582 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5583 @end example
5584
5585 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5586 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5587 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5588 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5589 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5590 @example
5591 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5592 @end example
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5596 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5597 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5598 @example
5599 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5600 @end example
5601 @end deffn
5602
5603 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5604 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5605 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5606 @end deffn
5607 @end deffn
5608
5609 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5610 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5611 @cindex xcf
5612 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5613 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5614 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5615 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5616 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5617
5618 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5619 command accepts additional parameters:
5620 @itemize
5621 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5622 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5623 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5624 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5625 in master mode.
5626 @end itemize
5627 @example
5628 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5629 @end example
5630 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5631 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5632 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5633 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5634 dedicated sector.
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5638 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5639 button.
5640 @example
5641 xcf configure 0
5642 @end example
5643 @end deffn
5644
5645 Additional driver notes:
5646 @itemize
5647 @item Only single revision supported.
5648 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5649 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5650 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5651 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5652 @end itemize
5653 @end deffn
5654
5655 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5656 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5657 @cindex SPIFI
5658 @cindex lpcspifi
5659 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5660 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5661 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5662
5663 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5664 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5665 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5666 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5667 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5668
5669 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5670 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5671 are configured by the driver.
5672
5673 @example
5674 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5675 @end example
5676
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5680 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5681 @cindex SMI
5682 @cindex stmsmi
5683 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5684 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5685 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5686 SPI flash devices.
5687 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5688 flash devices can be connected.
5689
5690 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5691 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5692 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5693 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5694 the flash content.
5695
5696 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5697 to identify the memory bank.
5698 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5699 flash size, are detected automatically.
5700
5701 @example
5702 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5703 @end example
5704
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5708 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5709 @cindex QuadSPI
5710 @cindex OctoSPI
5711 @cindex stmqspi
5712 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5713 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5714 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5715 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5716 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5717 mode is not.
5718
5719 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5720 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5721 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5722 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5723
5724 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5725 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5726 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5727
5728 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5729 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5730 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5731 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5732 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5733 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5734
5735 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5736 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5737 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5738 should be avoided.
5739
5740 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5741 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5742 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5743 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5744 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5745 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5746
5747 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5748 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5749 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5750 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5751 persist across openocd invocations.
5752
5753 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5754 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5755 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5756 required (see 'set' command).
5757
5758 @example
5759 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5760 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5761 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5762 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5763 @end example
5764
5765 There are three specific commands
5766 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5767 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5768 chip specific write protection engaged.
5769 @end deffn
5770
5771 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5772 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5773 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5774 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5775 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5776 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5777
5778 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5779 which don't support an id command.
5780
5781 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5782 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5783 @end deffn
5784
5785 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5786 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5787 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5788 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5789 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5790
5791 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5792 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5793 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5794 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5795
5796 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5797
5798 To check basic communication settings, issue
5799 @example
5800 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5801 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5802 @end example
5803 for single flash mode or
5804 @example
5805 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5806 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5807 @end example
5808 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5809
5810 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5811 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5812 need a dummy address, e.g.
5813 @example
5814 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5815 @end example
5816 should return the status register contents.
5817
5818 @end deffn
5819
5820 @end deffn
5821
5822 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5823 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5824 Microcontroller platform.
5825
5826 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5827 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5828
5829 @example
5830 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5831 @end example
5832
5833 @end deffn
5834
5835 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5836 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5837 @cindex ath79
5838 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5839 chip selects.
5840 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5841 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5842 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5843 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5844 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5845 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5846
5847 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5848 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5849 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5850 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5851 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5852 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5853 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5854 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5855 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5856 with the default CS0.
5857 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5858 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5859 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5860
5861 @example
5862 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5863
5864 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5865 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5866 # distinguish the banks.
5867 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5868 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5869 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5870 @end example
5871
5872 @end deffn
5873
5874 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5875 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5876 @cindex fespi
5877
5878 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5879
5880 @example
5881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5886
5887 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5888 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5889 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5890 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5891 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5892 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5893
5894 @example
5895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5896 @end example
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5900 @cindex ambiqmicro
5901 @cindex apollo
5902 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5903 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5904 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5905 with the target using SWD.
5906
5907 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5908 the device class of the MCU.
5909 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5910 to set up the flash banks.
5911 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5912 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5913
5914 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5915 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5916 and the second bank starts after the first.
5917
5918 @example
5919 # Flash bank 0
5920 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5921 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5923 $_TARGETNAME
5924 @end example
5925
5926 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5927 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5928 are available to the user.
5929
5930 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5931
5932 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5933 Erase entire bank.
5934 @end deffn
5935 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5936 Erase device pages.
5937 @end deffn
5938 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5939 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5940 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5941 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5942 the flash.
5943 @end deffn
5944 @end deffn
5945
5946 @anchor{at91samd}
5947 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5948 @cindex at91samd
5949 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5950 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5951
5952 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5953
5954 The devices have one flash bank:
5955
5956 @example
5957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5958 @end example
5959
5960 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5961 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5962 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5963 processor to be halted.
5964 @end deffn
5965
5966 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5967 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5968 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5969 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5970 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5971 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5972
5973 @example
5974 at91samd set-security enable
5975 @end example
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5979 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5980 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5981 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5982 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5983 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5984 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5985 in order to disable this feature.
5986
5987 @example
5988 at91samd eeprom
5989 at91samd eeprom 1024
5990 @end example
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5994 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5995 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5996 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5997 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5998 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5999
6000 @example
6001 at91samd bootloader
6002 at91samd bootloader 16384
6003 @end example
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6007 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6008 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6009 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6010 @end deffn
6011
6012 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6013 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6014 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6015 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6016 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6017 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6018 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6019 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6020
6021 @example
6022 # Read user row
6023 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6024 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6025 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6026 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6027 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6028 # byte unchanged
6029 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6030 @end example
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @anchor{at91sam3}
6036 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6037 @cindex at91sam3
6038 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6039 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6040 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6041 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6042 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6043 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6044 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6045 chips are confirmed.}
6046
6047 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6048 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6049 the following fixed locations:
6050
6051 @example
6052 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6053 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6054 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6055 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6056 @end example
6057
6058 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6059 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6060 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6061
6062 @itemize
6063 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6064 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6065 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6066 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6067 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6068 @end itemize
6069
6070 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6071
6072 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6073 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6074 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6075 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6076 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6077 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6078 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6079
6080 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6081 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6085 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6086 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6087 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6088 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6089 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6090 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6091 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6092 @end deffn
6093
6094 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6095 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6096 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6097 @end deffn
6098 @end deffn
6099
6100 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6101 @cindex at91sam4
6102 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6103 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6104 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6108 @cindex at91sam4l
6109 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6110 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6111 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6112
6113 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6114 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6115 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6116 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6117 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6118 @end deffn
6119 @end deffn
6120
6121 @anchor{atsame5}
6122 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6123 @cindex atsame5
6124 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6125 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6126 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6127
6128 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6129 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6130 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6131
6132 @example
6133 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6134 @end example
6135
6136 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6137 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6138 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6139 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6140 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6141 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6142
6143 @example
6144 atsame5 bootloader
6145 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6146 @end example
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6150 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6151 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6152 processor to be halted.
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6156 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6157 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6158 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6159 @end deffn
6160
6161 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6162 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6163 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6164 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6165 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6166 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6167 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6168 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6169
6170 @example
6171 # Read
6172 >atsame5 userpage
6173 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6174 # Write
6175 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6176 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6177 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6178 # bytes)
6179 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6180 @end example
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @end deffn
6184
6185 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6186 @cindex atsamv
6187 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6188 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6189 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6190 @end deffn
6191
6192 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6193 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6194 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6195 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6196 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6197
6198 @example
6199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6200 @end example
6201
6202 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6203 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6204
6205 @itemize
6206 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6207 @item @var{banks}
6208 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6209 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6210 @item @var{pages_size}
6211 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6212 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6213 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6214 @end itemize
6215
6216 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6217 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6218 will be autoconfigured.
6219 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6220
6221 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6222 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6223 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6224 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6225 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6226
6227 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6228 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6229 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6230 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6231 are not truly general purpose).
6232 @quotation Note
6233 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6234 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6235 @end quotation
6236 @end deffn
6237 @end deffn
6238
6239 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6240 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6241 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6242 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6243 @end deffn
6244
6245 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6246 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6247 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6248 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6249
6250 @example
6251 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6252 @end example
6253
6254 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6255 each single sector one by one.
6256
6257 @example
6258 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6259 @end example
6260
6261 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6262 @end deffn
6263
6264 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6265 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6266 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6267 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6268 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6269 starts at address 0.
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6277 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6278 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6279 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6280 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6281 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6282 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6283 and programming the serial flash.
6284
6285 @example
6286 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6287 @end example
6288 @end deffn
6289
6290 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6291 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6292 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6293 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6294 autoconfigures itself.
6295 @example
6296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6297 @end example
6298 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6299 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6300 this via the following command:
6301 @example
6302 efm32 debuglock num
6303 @end example
6304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6305 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6306 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6307 supported.}
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6311 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6312 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6313 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6314 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6315 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6316
6317 @example
6318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6319 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6320 @end example
6321
6322 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6323 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6327 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6328 is an uncommon operation.}
6329 @end deffn
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6333 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6334 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6335 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6336 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6337 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6338 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6339
6340 @example
6341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6342 @end example
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6346 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6347 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6348 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6349 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6350 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6351 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6352 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6353 characters) ignored.
6354
6355 @example
6356 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6357 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6358 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6359 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6360 @end example
6361 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6362 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6363 @end deffn
6364
6365 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6366 @cindex kinetis
6367 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6368 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6369 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6370 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6371 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6372 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6373
6374 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6375 @itemize
6376 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6377 @end itemize
6378
6379 @example
6380 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6381 @end example
6382
6383 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6384 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6385 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6386 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6387 @end deffn
6388
6389 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6390 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6391 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6392 set by 'flash protect' command.
6393 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6394 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6395 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6396 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6397 with the rest of a flash image.
6398 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6399 @end deffn
6400
6401 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6402 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6403 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6404 @end deffn
6405
6406 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6407 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6408 and examine-fail event.
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6412 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6413 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6414 @end deffn
6415
6416 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6417 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6418 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6419 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6420 command completes.
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6424 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6425 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6426 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6427 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6428
6429 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6430 Program Partition command.
6431
6432 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6433 Reset the device after partition setting.
6434
6435 Show partition size:
6436 @example
6437 kinetis nvm_partition info
6438 @end example
6439
6440 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6441 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6442 @example
6443 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6444 @end example
6445
6446 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6447 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6448 @example
6449 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6450 @end example
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6454 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6455 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6459 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6460 Command disables watchdog timer.
6461 @end deffn
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6465 @cindex kinetis_ke
6466 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6467 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6468 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6469 autoconfigures itself.
6470 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6471
6472 @example
6473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6474 @end example
6475
6476 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6477 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6481 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6482 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6483 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6484 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6488 Command disables watchdog timer.
6489 @end deffn
6490 @end deffn
6491
6492 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6493 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6494 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6495 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6496 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6497
6498 @quotation Note
6499 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6500 driver:
6501 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6502 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6503 @end quotation
6504
6505 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6506 which must appear in the following order:
6507
6508 @itemize
6509 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6510 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6511 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6512 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6513 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6514 LPC43x[2357])
6515 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6516 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6517 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6518 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6519 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6520 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6521 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6522 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6523 at which the core is running
6524 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6525 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6526 @quotation Note
6527 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6528 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6529 However, if you do provide it,
6530 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6531 @end quotation
6532 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6533 ROM IAP entry point.
6534 @end itemize
6535
6536 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6537
6538 @example
6539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6540 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6541 @end example
6542
6543 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6544 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6545 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6546 @end deffn
6547 @end deffn
6548
6549 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6550 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6551 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6552 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6553 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6554 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6555
6556 @example
6557 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6558 @end example
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6562 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6563 from NXP.
6564
6565 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6566 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6567 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6568 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6569 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6570 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6571 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6572 you start the PLL.
6573
6574 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6575
6576 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6577 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6578 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6579
6580 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6581 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6582 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6583 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6584 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6585 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6586 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6587
6588 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6589 @example
6590 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6591 @end example
6592
6593 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6594 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6595 @code{flash banks} command.
6596
6597 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6598 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6599 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6600 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6601 a known signature.
6602 Example:
6603 @example
6604 lpc2900 signature 0
6605 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6606 @end example
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6610 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6611 saves it to a file in binary format.
6612 Example:
6613 @example
6614 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6615 @end example
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6619 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6620 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6621 command:
6622
6623 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6624 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6625 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6626 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6627
6628 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6629 Example:
6630 @example
6631 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6632 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6633 @end example
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6637 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6638 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6639 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6640 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6641 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6642 912 bytes.
6643 @quotation Attention
6644 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6645 @end quotation
6646 Example:
6647 @example
6648 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6649 @end example
6650 @end deffn
6651
6652 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6653 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6654 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6655 after the next power cycle.
6656 @quotation Attention
6657 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6658 @end quotation
6659 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6660 Example:
6661 @example
6662 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6663 flash info 0
6664 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6665 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6666 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6667 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6668 @end example
6669 @end deffn
6670
6671 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6672 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6673 effective after the next power cycle.
6674 @quotation Attention
6675 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6676 @end quotation
6677 Examples:
6678 @example
6679 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6680 @end example
6681 @end deffn
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6685 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6686 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6687 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6688
6689 @example
6690 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6691 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6692 @end example
6693
6694 @itemize @bullet
6695 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6696 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6697 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6698 @end itemize
6699
6700 Example usage:
6701 @example
6702 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6703 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6704 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6705 @} else @{
6706 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6707 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6708 @}
6709 @end example
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6713 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6714 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6715 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6716 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6717 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6718
6719 @example
6720 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6721 @end example
6722
6723 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6724 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6725 only the main program flash.
6726
6727 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6728 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6729 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6733 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6734 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6735 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6736
6737 To erase and program the BSL:
6738 @example
6739 msp432 bsl unlock
6740 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6741 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6742 msp432 bsl lock
6743 @end example
6744 @end deffn
6745 @end deffn
6746
6747 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6748 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6749 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6750 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6751 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6752 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6753 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6754 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6755 also have division into regions: main and info.
6756 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6757 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6758
6759 @example
6760 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6761 @end example
6762
6763 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6764
6765 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6766 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6770 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6774 Erase all userflash including info region.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6778 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6779 @end deffn
6780
6781 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6782 Check sectors protect.
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6786 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6790 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6794 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6798 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6802 Show information about flash driver.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @end deffn
6806
6807 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6808 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6809 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6810 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6811 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6812
6813 @example
6814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6815 @end example
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6819 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6820 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6821 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6822 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6823
6824 @example
6825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6826 @end example
6827
6828 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6831 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6832 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6833 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6834 code.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6838 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @end deffn
6842
6843 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6844 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6845 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6846
6847 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6848 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6849 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6850 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6851
6852 @example
6853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6854 @end example
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6858 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6859 and integrate flash memory.
6860
6861 @example
6862 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6863 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6864 @end example
6865
6866 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6867 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6868 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6869 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6870 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6871 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6872 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6873 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6874 @end deffn
6875 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6876 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6877 This will remove any Code Protection.
6878 @end deffn
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6882 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6883 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6884 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6885 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6886
6887 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6888 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6889
6890 @example
6891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6892 @end example
6893
6894 psoc4-specific commands
6895 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6896 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6897
6898 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6899 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6900
6901 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6902 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6903 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6904
6905 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6909 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6910
6911 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6912 @end deffn
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6916 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6917 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6918 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6919 apart from the base address.
6920
6921 @example
6922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6923 @end example
6924
6925 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6926 @quotation Attention
6927 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6928 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6929 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6930 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6931 @end quotation
6932
6933 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6934
6935 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6936 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6937 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6938 @end deffn
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6942 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6943 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6944 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6945 apart from the base address.
6946
6947 @example
6948 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6949 $_TARGETNAME
6950 @end example
6951 @end deffn
6952
6953 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6954 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6955 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6956 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6957
6958 @example
6959 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6960 @end example
6961
6962 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6963
6964 @itemize
6965 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6966 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6967 @end itemize
6968
6969 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6970
6971 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6972 @quotation Attention
6973 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6974 after successful write.
6975 @end quotation
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6979 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6980 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6981 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6982
6983 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6984 @itemize @bullet
6985 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6986 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6987 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6988 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6989 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6990 row size: 512 bytes.
6991 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6992 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6993 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6994 operation will erase row automatically.
6995 @end itemize
6996
6997 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6998 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6999
7000 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7001
7002 @example
7003 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7004 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7005 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7006 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7007 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7008 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7009 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7010 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7011 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7012 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7013 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7014 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7015
7016 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7017 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7018 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7019 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7020 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7021 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7022 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7023 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7024 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7025 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7026 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7027 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7028 @end example
7029
7030 psoc6-specific commands
7031 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7032 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7033 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7034 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7035 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7036 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7037 @end deffn
7038
7039 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7040 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7041 by @command{flash banks}.
7042 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7043 @end deffn
7044 @end deffn
7045
7046 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7047 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7048 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7049 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7050 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7051
7052 @example
7053 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7054 @end example
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7058 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7059 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7060 and SWD interface.
7061 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7062 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7063
7064 @example
7065 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7066 @end example
7067
7068 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7069
7070 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7071 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7072 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7076 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7077 @end deffn
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7081 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7082 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7083 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7084 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7085
7086 @example
7087 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7088 @end example
7089
7090 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7091 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7092 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7093 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7094 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7095 disabled.
7096
7097 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7098 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7099 @quotation Warning
7100 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7101 applied to all of them.
7102 @end quotation
7103 @end deffn
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7107 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7108 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7109 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7110 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7111 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7112
7113 @example
7114 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7115 @end example
7116
7117 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7118 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7119 the flash driver.
7120
7121 @example
7122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7123 @end example
7124
7125 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7126 as per the following example.
7127 @example
7128 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7129 @end example
7130
7131 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7132
7133 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7134 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7135 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7139 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7140 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7141 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7142 @end deffn
7143
7144 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7145 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7146 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7147 @end deffn
7148
7149 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7150 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7151 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7152 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7156 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7157 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7158 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7162 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7163 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7164 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 @end deffn
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7170 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7171 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7172 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7173 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7174
7175 @example
7176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7177 @end example
7178
7179 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7180 as per the following example.
7181 @example
7182 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7183 @end example
7184
7185 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7186 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7187 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7191 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7192 the flash driver.
7193
7194 @example
7195 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7196 @end example
7197
7198 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7199
7200 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7201 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7202 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7203 @end deffn
7204
7205 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7206 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7207 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7211 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7212 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7216 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7221 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7222 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7223 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7224 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7225 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7229 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7230 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7231 @end deffn
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7235 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7236 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7237 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7238 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7239
7240 @example
7241 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7242 @end example
7243
7244 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7245 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7246 the flash driver.
7247
7248 @example
7249 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7250 @end example
7251
7252 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7253
7254 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7255 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7256 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7260 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7261 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7262 @end deffn
7263
7264 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7265 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7266 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7267 @end deffn
7268
7269 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7270 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7271 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7272 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7273 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7274
7275 Example usage:
7276 @example
7277 # read OPTSR_CUR
7278 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7279 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7280 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7281 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7282 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7283 @end example
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7287 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7289 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7290 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7291 will be touched).
7292
7293 Example usage:
7294 @example
7295 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7296 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7297 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7298 @end example
7299 @end deffn
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7303 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7304 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7305 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7306 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7307
7308 @example
7309 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7310 @end example
7311
7312 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7313 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7314 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7315 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7316 second bank.
7317
7318 @example
7319 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7320 @end example
7321
7322 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7323
7324 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7325 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7330 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7331 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7335 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7336 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7337 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7338 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7339 @end deffn
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7343 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7344 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7345 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7346 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7347 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7348
7349 @example
7350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7351 @end example
7352
7353 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7354 as per the following example.
7355 @example
7356 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7357 @end example
7358
7359 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7360 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7361 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7365 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7366 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7367 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7368
7369 @example
7370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7371 @end example
7372
7373 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7374
7375 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7376 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7377 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7378
7379 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7383 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7384 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7385
7386 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7390 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7391 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7392 @end deffn
7393
7394 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7395 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7396 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7397 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7398
7399 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7400 @example
7401 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7402 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7403 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7404 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7405 @end example
7406
7407 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7408 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7412 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7413 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7414 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7415 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7416
7417 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7418
7419 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7420 @example
7421 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7422 @end example
7423
7424 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7425 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7426 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7430 List the protected areas using WRP.
7431 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7432 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7433 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7434
7435 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7436 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7437 in single or dual-banks mode.
7438 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7439 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7440
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7444 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7445 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7446 @end deffn
7447
7448 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7449 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7450 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7451 the TrustZone status.
7452 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7453 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7454 @end deffn
7455 @end deffn
7456
7457 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7458 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7459 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7460 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7461 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7462
7463 @example
7464 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7465 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7466 @end example
7467
7468 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7469 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7470 for the specified flash bank.
7471 @end deffn
7472 @end deffn
7473
7474 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7475 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7476 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7477 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7478 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7479
7480 @example
7481 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7482 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7483 @end example
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7486 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7487 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7488
7489 @itemize @bullet
7490 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7491 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7492 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7493 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7494 @end itemize
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7500 @cindex str9xpec
7501
7502 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7503 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7504 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7505 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7506
7507 Here is some background info to help
7508 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7509 the str9:
7510 @enumerate
7511 @item
7512 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7513 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7514 @item
7515 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7516 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7517 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7518 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7519 @end enumerate
7520
7521 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7522 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7523 configured for flash bank 0.
7524 @example
7525 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7526 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7527 adapter assert srst
7528 # turn off target polling
7529 poll off
7530 # disable str9 core
7531 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7532 # read option bytes
7533 str9xpec options_read 0
7534 # re-enable str9 core
7535 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7536 poll on
7537 reset halt
7538 @end example
7539 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7540 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7541 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7542 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7543
7544 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7545
7546 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7547 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7548 @end deffn
7549
7550 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7551 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7552 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7556 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7557 erase the device.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7561 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7562 @end deffn
7563
7564 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7565 Configure str9 boot bank.
7566 @end deffn
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7569 Configure str9 lvd source.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7573 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7577 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7581 Read str9 option bytes.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7585 Write str9 option bytes.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7589 unlock str9 device.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7595 @cindex swm050
7596 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7597
7598 @example
7599 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7600 @end example
7601
7602 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7603
7604 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7605 Erases the entire flash bank.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610
7611 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7612 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7613 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7614 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7615
7616 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7617
7618 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7619 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7620 @end deffn
7621
7622 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7623 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7627 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7628 the flash clock.
7629 @end deffn
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7633 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7634 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7635 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7636 correct bank config.
7637
7638 @example
7639 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7640 @end example
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7644 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7645 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7649 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7650 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7651
7652 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7653
7654 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7655 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7659 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7660 @end deffn
7661
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @section NAND Flash Commands
7665 @cindex NAND
7666
7667 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7668 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7669 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7670
7671 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7672 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7673 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7674 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7675 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7676 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7677
7678 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7679 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7680 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7681 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7682 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7683 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7684 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7685 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7686 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7687 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7688
7689 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7690 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7691 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7692 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7693 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7694 every 512 bytes of data.
7695
7696 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7697 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7698 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7699 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7700 ECC mode is used.
7701
7702 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7703 @enumerate
7704 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7705 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7706 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7707 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7708 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7709 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7710 to access that device.
7711 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7712 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7713 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7714 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7715 de-brick a board.
7716 @end enumerate
7717
7718 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7719 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7720 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7721 are only 32 bits wide.
7722 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7723 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7724 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7725 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7726
7727 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7728 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7729 @cindex NAND configuration
7730
7731 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7732 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7733 OpenOCD has initialized.
7734
7735 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7736 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7737 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7738 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7739 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7740 they were a single (larger) device.
7741 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7742 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7743
7744 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7745 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7746 configuration files, not interactively.
7747
7748 @itemize @bullet
7749 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7750 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7751 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7752 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7753 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7754 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7755 commands to the NAND controller.
7756 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7757 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7758 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7759 for more information.
7760 @end itemize
7761 @end deffn
7762
7763 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7764 Prints a summary of each device declared
7765 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7766 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7767 @example
7768 > nand list
7769 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7770 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7771 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7772 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7773 >
7774 @end example
7775 @end deffn
7776
7777 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7778 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7779 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7780 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7781 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7782 it with most other NAND commands.
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7786
7787 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7788 @cindex NAND reading
7789 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7790 starting at the specified offset.
7791 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7792
7793 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7794 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7795
7796 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7797 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7798 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7799
7800 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7801 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7802 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7803 method which handled that error correction.
7804
7805 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7806 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7807 @itemize @bullet
7808 @item no oob_* parameter
7809 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7810 @item @code{oob_raw}
7811 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7812 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7813 spare areas associated with each data page.
7814 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7815 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7816 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7817 @item @code{oob_only}
7818 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7819 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7820 spare areas associated with each data page.
7821 @end itemize
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7825 @cindex NAND erasing
7826 @cindex NAND programming
7827 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7828 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7829 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7830 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7831 If those parameters are not specified,
7832 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7833 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7834
7835 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7836 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7837 block marker.
7838 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7839 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7840 @end deffn
7841
7842 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7843 @cindex NAND writing
7844 @cindex NAND programming
7845 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7846 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7847 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7848 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7849
7850 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7851 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7852
7853 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7854 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7855 past the end of the device.
7856 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7857 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7858 if that's being written.)
7859
7860 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7861 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7862 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7863
7864 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7865 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7866 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7867 @itemize @bullet
7868 @item no oob_* parameter
7869 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7870 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7871 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7872 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7873 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7874 @item @code{oob_only}
7875 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7876 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7877 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7878 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7879 @item @code{oob_raw}
7880 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7881 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7882 un-altered OOB.
7883 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7884 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7885 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7886 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7887 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7888 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7889 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7890 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7891 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7892 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7893 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7894 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7895 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7896 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7897 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7898 @end itemize
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7902 @cindex NAND verification
7903 @cindex NAND programming
7904 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7905 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7906 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7907
7908 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7909 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7910
7911 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7912 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7913 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7914 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7915 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7916
7917 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7918 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7919 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7920
7921 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7922 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7923 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7924 be removed in a future release.
7925 @end deffn
7926
7927 @subsection Other NAND commands
7928 @cindex NAND other commands
7929
7930 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7931 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7932 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7933 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7934 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7935 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7936 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7937 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7938
7939 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7940 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7941 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7942 @end deffn
7943
7944 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7945 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7946 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7947 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7948 status for each block.
7949 @end deffn
7950
7951 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7952 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7953 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7954
7955 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7956 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7957 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7958 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7959 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7960
7961 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7962 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7963 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7964 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7965 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7966 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7967 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7971 @subsection NAND Driver List
7972 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7973 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7974 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7975
7976 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7977 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7978 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7979 address of the ECC controller.
7980 @example
7981 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7982 @end example
7983 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7984 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7985 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7986 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7987 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7988 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7989 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7990 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7991 @end deffn
7992 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7993 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7994 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7998 properly configured for input or output.
7999 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8000 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8001 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8002 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8003 @end deffn
8004 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8005 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8006 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8007 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8008 @end deffn
8009 @end deffn
8010
8011 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8012 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8013 chips from Texas Instruments.
8014 It takes three extra parameters:
8015 address of the NAND chip;
8016 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8017 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8018 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8019 @example
8020 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8021 @end example
8022 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8023 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8024 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8025 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8026 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8030 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8031 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8032 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8033 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8034 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8035 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8039 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8040 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8041 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8042 @end deffn
8043 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8044
8045 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8046 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8047 should work for this chip as well.
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8051 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8052 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8053 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8054 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8055 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8056 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8057 @example
8058 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8059 @end example
8060 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8061 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8062 without parameter query status.
8063 @end deffn
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8067 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8068 parameter: the address of the controller.
8069 @example
8070 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8071 @end example
8072 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8073 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8074 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8075 change any behavior.
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8079 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8080 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8081 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8082 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8083 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8084 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8085 specialized commands.
8086 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8087 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8088 change any behavior.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @node Flash Programming
8092 @chapter Flash Programming
8093
8094 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8095 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8096 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8097
8098 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8099 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8100
8101 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8102 @enumerate
8103 @item 'init' is executed.
8104 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8105 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8106 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8107 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8108 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8109 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8110 @end enumerate
8111
8112 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8113
8114 @example
8115 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8116 # are optional parameters
8117 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8118 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8119
8120 # binary files need the flash address passing
8121 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8122 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8123 @end example
8124
8125 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8126 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8127 @cindex PLD
8128 @cindex FPGA
8129
8130 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8131 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8132 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8133 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8134 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8135 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8136 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8137
8138 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8139
8140 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8141 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8142 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8143
8144 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8145 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8146
8147 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8148 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8149 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8150 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8151 behavior.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8155 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8156 @end deffn
8157
8158 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8159 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8160 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8161 @end deffn
8162
8163 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8164
8165 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8166 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8167 that particular type of PLD.
8168
8169 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8170 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8171 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8172
8173 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8174 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8175 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8176
8177 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8178 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8179 for FPGA @var{num}.
8180 @end deffn
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @node General Commands
8184 @chapter General Commands
8185 @cindex commands
8186
8187 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8188 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8189 commands are documented elsewhere.
8190
8191 Intent:
8192 @itemize @bullet
8193 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8194 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8195 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8196 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8197
8198 @item @b{From the human}
8199 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8200 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8201
8202 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8203 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8204 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8205
8206 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8207 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8208 port is 5555.
8209 @end itemize
8210
8211
8212 @section Server Commands
8213
8214 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8215 Exits the current telnet session.
8216 @end deffn
8217
8218 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8219 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8220 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8221 Not every command provides helptext.
8222
8223 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8224 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8225 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8226 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8227 @end deffn
8228
8229 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8230 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8231 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8232 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8233 Useful in connection with script files
8234 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8235 @end deffn
8236
8237 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8238 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8239 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8240 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8241
8242 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8243 @example
8244 # redefine shutdown
8245 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8246 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8247 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8248 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8249 original_shutdown
8250 @}
8251 @end example
8252 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8253 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8254 @end deffn
8255
8256 @anchor{debuglevel}
8257 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8258 @cindex message level
8259 Display debug level.
8260 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8261 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8262 Level 0 is error messages only;
8263 level 1 adds warnings;
8264 level 2 adds informational messages;
8265 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8266 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8267 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8268 the command line along with the location of that log
8269 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8270 @xref{Running}.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8274 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8275 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8276 @example
8277 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8278 @end example
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8282 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8283 the default log output channel is stderr.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8287 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8291 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8292 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8293 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8294 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8298 @section Target State handling
8299 @cindex reset
8300 @cindex halt
8301 @cindex target initialization
8302
8303 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8304 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8305 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8306 a current target which is used to perform the
8307 various operations. The current target may be changed
8308 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8309 target which should become current.
8310
8311 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8312 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8313 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8314 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8315 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8316
8317 @emph{With no arguments}:
8318 list all available registers for the current target,
8319 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8320 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8321 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8322 are flagged as such.
8323
8324 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8325 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8326 bypassing any internal cache.
8327
8328 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8329 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8330 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8331 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8332 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8333 relevant module will flush such values.
8334
8335 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8336 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8337
8338 @example
8339 > reg
8340 ===== ARM registers
8341 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8342 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8343 (2) r2 (/32)
8344 ...
8345 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8346 >
8347 @end example
8348 @end deffn
8349
8350 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8351 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8352 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8353 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8354 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8355 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8356 (and enter debug mode).
8357 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8358
8359 @quotation Warning
8360 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8361 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8362 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8363 power mode by gating the core clock;
8364 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8365
8366 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8367 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8368 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8369 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8370 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8371 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8372
8373 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8374 work with a JTAG debugger.
8375 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8376 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8377 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8378 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8379 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8380 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8381 @end quotation
8382
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8386 Resume the target at its current code position,
8387 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8388 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8389 @end deffn
8390
8391 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8392 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8393 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8394 @end deffn
8395
8396 @anchor{resetcommand}
8397 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8398 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8399 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8400 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8401 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8402 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8403 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8404
8405 The optional parameter specifies what should
8406 happen after the reset.
8407 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8408 The other options will not work on all systems.
8409 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8410
8411 @itemize @minus
8412 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8413 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8414 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8415 @end itemize
8416 @end deffn
8417
8418 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8419 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8420 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8421 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8422 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8423 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8424 state.
8425 @end deffn
8426
8427 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8428 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8429 Set values of reset signals.
8430 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8431 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8432 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8433 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8434
8435 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8436 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8437 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8438 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8439 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8440 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8441 the signal will not be modified.
8442
8443 @quotation Note
8444 TRST is specially handled.
8445 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8446 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8447 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8448 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8449 instead of the TRST signal.
8450 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8451 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8452 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8453 with handlers for that event.
8454 @end quotation
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8458 @section Memory access commands
8459 @cindex memory access
8460
8461 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8462 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8463 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8464 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8465
8466 @enumerate
8467 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8468 to change the current target.
8469 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8470 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8471 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8472 @end enumerate
8473
8474 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8475 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8476 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8477 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8478 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8479 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8480 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8481 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8482 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8483 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8484 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8485 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8486 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8487 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8488 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8492 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8493 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8494 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8495 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8496 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8497 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8498 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8499 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8500 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8501 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8502 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @anchor{imageaccess}
8506 @section Image loading commands
8507 @cindex image loading
8508 @cindex image dumping
8509
8510 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8511 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8512 binary file named @var{filename}.
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8516 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8517 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8518 @end deffn
8519
8520 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8521 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8522 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8523 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8524 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8525 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8526 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8527 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8528 separately.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8532 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8533 The file format may optionally be specified
8534 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8535 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8536 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8537 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8538 @example
8539 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8540 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8541 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8542 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8543 $address $length
8544 @}
8545 @end example
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8549 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8550 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8551 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8552 The file format may optionally be specified
8553 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8554 @end deffn
8555
8556 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8557 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8558 The file format may optionally be specified
8559 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8560 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8561 @end deffn
8562
8563 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8564 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8565 The file format may optionally be specified
8566 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8567 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8568 @end deffn
8569
8570
8571 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8572 @cindex breakpoint
8573 @cindex watchpoint
8574
8575 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8576 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8577 watchpoints.
8578 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8581 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8582 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8583 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8584 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8585 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8586
8587 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8588 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8589 @end deffn
8590
8591 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8592 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8593 @end deffn
8594
8595 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8596 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8600 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8601 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8602 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8603 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8604 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8605 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8606 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8607 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8608 @end deffn
8609
8610
8611 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8612
8613 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8614 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8615 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8616 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8617 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8618 running, can be used.
8619 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8620 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8621 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8622
8623 @quotation Note
8624 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8625 @end quotation
8626
8627 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8628 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8629 communication, respectively.
8630
8631 @quotation Note
8632 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8633 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8634 example.
8635 @end quotation
8636
8637 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8638 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8639 of TCP/IP connections.
8640
8641 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8642 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8643 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8644 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8645 @var{size} bytes.
8646 @end deffn
8647
8648 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8649 Start RTT.
8650 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8651 @end deffn
8652
8653 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8654 Stop RTT.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8658 Display the polling interval.
8659 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8660 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8661 checked for new data.
8662 @end deffn
8663
8664 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8665 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8666 @end deffn
8667
8668 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8669 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8670 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8671 @end deffn
8672
8673 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8674 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8678 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8682 on the target device.
8683
8684 @example
8685 resume
8686
8687 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8688 rtt start
8689
8690 rtt server start 9090 0
8691 @end example
8692
8693 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8694 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8695 TCP/IP port 9090.
8696
8697
8698 @section Misc Commands
8699
8700 @cindex profiling
8701 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8702 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8703 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8704 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8705 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8706 limit the address range.
8707 @end deffn
8708
8709 @deffn {Command} {version}
8710 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8714 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8715 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8719 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8720 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8721 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8722
8723 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8724 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8725 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8726 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8727
8728 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8729 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8730 @cindex tracing
8731 @cindex ETM
8732 @cindex ETB
8733
8734 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8735 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8736 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8737
8738 @itemize
8739 @item
8740 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8741 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8742 supports such an interface.
8743 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8744 and trace port support.)
8745 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8746 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8747 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8748 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8749 in the board-specific configuration file.
8750 @item
8751 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8752 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8753 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8754 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8755 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8756 @end itemize
8757
8758 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8759
8760 @quotation Issues
8761 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8762 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8763
8764 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8765 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8766 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8767 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8768 dummy trace port driver}.
8769
8770 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8771 as well as tracing only during specific states
8772 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8773
8774 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8775 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8776 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8777 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8778 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8779
8780 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8781 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8782 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8783 this original style of JTAG access.
8784 @end quotation
8785
8786 @subsection ETM Configuration
8787 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8788
8789 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8790 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8791 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8792
8793 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8794 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8795 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8796 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8797 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8798 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8799 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8800 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8801 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8802
8803 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8804 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8805 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8806
8807 @quotation Warning
8808 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8809 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8810 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8811 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8812 @end quotation
8813
8814 @quotation Note
8815 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8816 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8817 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8818 what CPU activities are traced.
8819 @end quotation
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8823 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8824 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8825 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8826 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8830 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8831 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8832 Did trace data overflow?
8833 Was it triggered?
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8837 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8838 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8839 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8840 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8841
8842 @itemize
8843 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8844 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8845 The value is one of
8846 @option{none} (save nothing),
8847 @option{data} (save data),
8848 @option{address} (save addresses),
8849 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8850 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8851 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8852 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8853 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8854 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8855 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8856 trace stream without an image of the code.
8857 @end itemize
8858 @end deffn
8859
8860 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8861 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8862 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8863 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8864 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8865
8866 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8867 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8868 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8869 @end deffn
8870
8871 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8872
8873 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8874 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8875 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8876
8877 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8878 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8879 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8880 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8881 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8882 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8883 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8884
8885 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8886
8887 @itemize
8888 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8889 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8890 for instruction access within that function's body.
8891 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8892 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8893 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8894 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8895 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8896 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8897 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8898 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8899 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8900 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8901 @item @emph{... more}
8902 @end itemize
8903
8904 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8905 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8906
8907 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8908 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8909 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8910 @end deffn
8911
8912 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8913 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8917 Opens an image file.
8918 @end deffn
8919
8920 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8921 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8922 @end deffn
8923
8924 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8925 Starts trace data collection.
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8929 Stops trace data collection.
8930 @end deffn
8931
8932 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8933 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8934
8935 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8936
8937 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8938 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8939 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8940 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8941 any trace data collection.}
8942 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8943 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8944 @end deffn
8945 @end deffn
8946
8947 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8948 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8949 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8950 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8951 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8952 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8953 @end deffn
8954 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8955 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8956 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8957 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8958 trace trigger becomes active.
8959
8960 @itemize
8961 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8962 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8963 afterwards.
8964 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8965 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8966 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8967 what caused that event to happen.
8968 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8969 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8970 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8971 how the event caused trouble.
8972 @end itemize
8973 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @end deffn
8977
8978 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8979 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8980 @cindex CTI
8981
8982 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8983 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8984 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8985 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8986 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8987 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8988
8989 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8990 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8991 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8992 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8993 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8994 including additional configuration.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8998 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9002 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9006 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9010 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9014 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9018 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9019 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9023 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9024 of the CTI.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9028 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9029 useful in TCL scripting.
9030 @end deffn
9031
9032 @section Generic ARM
9033 @cindex ARM
9034
9035 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9036 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9037 commands that may be available.
9038
9039 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9040 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9041 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9042 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9043 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9044 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9048 @cindex disassemble
9049 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9050 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9051 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9052 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9053 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9054 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9055 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9056
9057 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9058 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9059 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9060 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9061 with a handful of exceptions.
9062 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9063 @end deffn
9064
9065 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9066 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9067 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9068 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9069 and using the MCR instruction.
9070 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9071 an ARM register.)
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9075 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9076 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9077 and the MRC instruction.
9078 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9079 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9080 an ARM register.)
9081 @end deffn
9082
9083 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9084 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9085 core mode if necessary.
9086 @end deffn
9087
9088 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9089 @cindex ARM semihosting
9090 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9091
9092 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9093 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9094 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9095 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9096 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9097 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9098 @end deffn
9099
9100 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9101 @cindex ARM semihosting
9102 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9103
9104 @example
9105 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9106 @end example
9107
9108 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9109 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9110 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9111 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9112 @end deffn
9113
9114 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9115 @cindex ARM semihosting
9116 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9117 status.
9118
9119 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9120 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9121 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9122 debugger.
9123 @end deffn
9124
9125 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9126 @cindex ARM semihosting
9127 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9128
9129 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9130 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9131 the value returned by the target.
9132
9133 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9134 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9135 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9136 encountering a break.
9137
9138 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9139 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9140 to the debugger.
9141 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9142 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9143 request or equivalent").
9144
9145 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9146 this option (default: disabled).
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9150 @cindex ARMv4
9151 @cindex ARMv5
9152
9153 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9154 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9155 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9156 variant.
9157
9158 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9159 @cindex ARM7
9160 @cindex ARM9
9161
9162 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9163 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9164 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9165 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9166
9167 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9168 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9169 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9170 instead of breakpoints.
9171 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9172
9173 This should be
9174 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9175 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9176 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9180 @cindex DCC
9181 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9182 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9183 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9184
9185 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9186 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9187 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9188 @end deffn
9189
9190 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9191 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9192 that don't check completion of the operation.
9193 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9194
9195 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9196 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9197 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9198 @end deffn
9199
9200 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9201 @cindex ARM9
9202
9203 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9204 integer processors.
9205 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9206
9207 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9208 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9209 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9210 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9211
9212 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9213 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9214 @cindex vector_catch
9215 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9216 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9217 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9218 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9219 to those hardware vectors.
9220
9221 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9222 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9223 vector catch hardware to intercept
9224 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9225 @option{none} of them,
9226 or a list with one or more of the following:
9227 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9228 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9229 @end deffn
9230
9231 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9232 @cindex ARM920T
9233
9234 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9235 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9236 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9237 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9238 and ARM9 commands.
9239
9240 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9241 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9242 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9243 @end deffn
9244
9245 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9246 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9247 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9248 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9249 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9250 (Not all registers can be written.)
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9254 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9255 @end deffn
9256
9257 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9258 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9262 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9263
9264 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9265 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9266 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9267 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9268 and ARM9 commands.
9269
9270 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9271 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9272
9273 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9274 Print information about the caches found.
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9278 @cindex ARM966E
9279
9280 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9281 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9282 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9283 and ARM9 commands.
9284
9285 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9286 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9287 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9288 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9289 ARM966E-S TRM.
9290 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9291 as required for BIST support.
9292 @end deffn
9293
9294 @subsection XScale specific commands
9295 @cindex XScale
9296
9297 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9298
9299 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9300 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9301 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9302 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9303 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9304 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9305 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9306
9307 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9308 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9309 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9310 the mini-IC.
9311
9312 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9313 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9314 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9315 code layout in memory:
9316 @example
9317 _vectors:
9318 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9319 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9320 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9321 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9322 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9323 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9324 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9325 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9326 .org 0x100
9327 .long real_reset_vector
9328 .long real_ui_handler
9329 .long real_swi_handler
9330 .long real_pf_abort
9331 .long real_data_abort
9332 .long 0 /* unused */
9333 .long real_irq_handler
9334 .long real_fiq_handler
9335 @end example
9336
9337 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9338 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9339 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9340 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9341 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9342 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9343 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9344 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9345 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9346 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9347 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9348 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9349 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9350 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9351 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9352 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9353 software.
9354
9355 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9356 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9357 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9358 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9359
9360 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9361 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9362 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9363 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9364 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9365 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9366 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9367 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9368 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9369
9370 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9371 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9372
9373 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9374 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9378 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9379 @end deffn
9380
9381 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9382 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9383 @end deffn
9384
9385 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9386 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9387 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9391 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9395 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9399 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9403 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9407 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9411 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9412 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9413 and modifying how it is emptied.
9414 @end deffn
9415
9416 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9417 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9418 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9419 The image @var{type} may be one of
9420 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9421 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9422 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9423 @end deffn
9424
9425 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9426 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9427 @cindex vector_catch
9428 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9429 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9430
9431 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9432 @example
9433 0x01 Trap Reset
9434 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9435 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9436 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9437 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9438 0x20 reserved
9439 0x40 Trap IRQ
9440 0x80 Trap FIQ
9441 @end example
9442 @end deffn
9443
9444 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9445 @cindex vector_table
9446
9447 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9448 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9449 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9450 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9451 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9452
9453 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9454
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9458 @cindex ARMv6
9459
9460 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9461 @cindex ARM11
9462
9463 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9464 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9465 which is enabled by default.
9466 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9467 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9468 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9469 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9470 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9471 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9475 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9476 which is enabled by default.
9477 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9478 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9479 @end deffn
9480
9481 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9482 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9483 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9484 they are disabled by default.
9485 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9489 @cindex vector_catch
9490 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9491 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9492 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9493
9494 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9495 for certain hardware events.
9496 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9497 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9498 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9502 @cindex ARMv7
9503 @cindex ARMv8
9504
9505 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9506 @cindex Cortex-A
9507
9508 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9509 display information about target caches
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9513 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9514 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9515 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9516 Defaults to 'off'.
9517 @end deffn
9518
9519 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9520 Initialize core debug
9521 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9525 Display/set the current SMP mode
9526 @end deffn
9527
9528 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9529 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9533 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9534 @end deffn
9535
9536 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9537 configure l2x cache
9538 @end deffn
9539
9540 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9541 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9542 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9543 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9544 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9548 @cindex Cortex-R
9549
9550 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9551 Initialize core debug
9552 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9556 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559
9560 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9561 @cindex tracing
9562 @cindex SWO
9563 @cindex SWV
9564 @cindex TPIU
9565
9566 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9567 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9568 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9569 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9570
9571 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9572 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9573 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9574 which causes quite some confusion.
9575 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9576 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9577
9578 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9579 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9580 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9581
9582 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9583 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9584 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9585 @end deffn
9586
9587 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9588 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9589 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9590 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9591
9592 @itemize @bullet
9593 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9594 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9595 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9596 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9597
9598 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9599 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9600 @end itemize
9601 @end deffn
9602
9603 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9604 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9605 @end deffn
9606
9607 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9608 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9609 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9610 at any time after the initialization, too.
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9614 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9615 individually queried, to return its current value.
9616 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9617 @end deffn
9618
9619 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9620 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9621 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9622 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9623
9624 @itemize @bullet
9625 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9626 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9627
9628 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9629 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9630
9631 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9632 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9633
9634 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9635 protocol used for trace data:
9636 @itemize @minus
9637 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9638 data bits (default);
9639 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9640 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9641 @end itemize
9642
9643 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9644 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9645 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9646 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9647 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9648 of the TPIU.
9649
9650 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9651 the destination of the trace data:
9652 @itemize @minus
9653 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9654 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9655 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9656 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9657 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9658 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9659 each connected client;
9660 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9661 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9662 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9663 @end itemize
9664
9665 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9666 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9667 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9668 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9669
9670 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9671 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9672 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9673 maximum supported rate automatically.
9674
9675 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9676 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9677 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9678
9679 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9680 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9681 default value is @var{0}.
9682 @end itemize
9683 @end deffn
9684
9685 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9686 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9687 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9688 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9689 data.
9690 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9691 after the @command{init}.
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9695 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698
9699
9700 Example usage:
9701 @enumerate
9702 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9703 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9704 enough to:
9705 @example
9706 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9707 ...
9708 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9709 ...
9710 @end example
9711 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9712 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9713 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9714 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9715 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9716 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9717 @example
9718 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9719 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9720 @end example
9721 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9722 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9723 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9724 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9725 @example
9726 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9727 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9728 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9729 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9730 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9731 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9732 @end example
9733 @end enumerate
9734
9735 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9736 @cindex tracing
9737 @cindex SWO
9738 @cindex SWV
9739 @cindex ITM
9740 @cindex ETM
9741
9742 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9743 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9744 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9745 @end deffn
9746
9747 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9748 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9749 @end deffn
9750
9751 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9752 @cindex Cortex-M
9753
9754 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9755 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9756
9757 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9758 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9759 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9760 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9761 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9762 the step command leaves with the core running.
9763
9764 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9765 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9766 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9767 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9768
9769 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9770 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9771 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9772 does.
9773
9774 Default is @option{auto}.
9775 @end deffn
9776
9777 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9778 @cindex vector_catch
9779 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9780 for certain hardware events.
9781
9782 Parameters request interception of
9783 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9784 @option{none} of them,
9785 or one or more of the following:
9786 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9787 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9788 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9789 @option{irq_err},
9790 @option{state_err},
9791 @option{chk_err}, or
9792 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9793 @option{reset}.
9794 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9795 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9796 are mapped to HardFault.
9797 UsageFault checks for
9798 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9799 must also be explicitly enabled.
9800
9801 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9802 @end deffn
9803
9804 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9805 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9806 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9807
9808 @itemize @minus
9809 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9810 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9811 @end itemize
9812
9813 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9814 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9815 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9816 to manually reset the peripherals.
9817 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9818
9819 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9820 instead.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9824 @cindex ARMv8-A
9825 @cindex aarch64
9826
9827 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9828 Display information about target caches
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9832 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9833 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9834 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9835 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9836 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9840 @cindex disassemble
9841 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9842 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9843 @end deffn
9844
9845 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9846 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9847 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9848 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9849 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9853 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9854 @option{on}.
9855 @end deffn
9856
9857 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9858 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9859 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9860 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9861 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9862 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9866
9867 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9868 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9869
9870 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9871
9872 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9873 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9874 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9878 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9879 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9880 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9881 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9882 @end deffn
9883
9884 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9885
9886 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9887 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9888 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9889 @end deffn
9890
9891 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9892
9893 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9894 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9895 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9896 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9897 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9898 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9899 can be collected.
9900
9901 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9902 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9903 tooling.
9904
9905 @quotation Issues
9906 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9907 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9908 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9909 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9910
9911 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9912 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9913 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9914 software operation on the CPU.
9915 @end quotation
9916
9917 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9918 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9919 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9920 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9921 @end deffn
9922
9923 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9924 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9925 @end deffn
9926
9927 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9928 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9929 control is disabled.
9930 @end deffn
9931
9932 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9933 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9934 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9935 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9936
9937 Supported trace formats:
9938 @itemize
9939 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9940 timing to be determined.
9941 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9942 addresses.
9943 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9944 @end itemize
9945 @end deffn
9946
9947 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9948 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9949 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9950 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9951
9952 Supported conditions:
9953 @itemize
9954 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9955 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9956 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9957 instruction matches start data and mask.
9958 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9959 instruction matches start data and mask.
9960 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9961 data and mask.
9962 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9963 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9964 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9965 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9966 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9967 @end itemize
9968 @end deffn
9969
9970 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9971 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9972 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9973 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9974
9975 Supported conditions:
9976 @itemize
9977 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9978 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9979 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9980 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9981 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9982 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9983 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9984 data and mask.
9985 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9986 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9987 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9988 @end itemize
9989 @end deffn
9990
9991 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9992 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9993
9994 Supported triggers:
9995 @itemize
9996 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9997 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9998 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9999 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10000 collection.
10001 @end itemize
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10005
10006 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10007 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10008 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10009 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10010 @end deffn
10011
10012 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10013 Display trace configuration.
10014 @end deffn
10015
10016 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10017 Display trace collection status.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10021 Start manual trace collection.
10022 @end deffn
10023
10024 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10025 Stop manual trace collection.
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10029 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10030 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10031 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10032 @option{size} options using DMA.
10033 @end deffn
10034
10035 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10036 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10037 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10038 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10039 @option{size} options using DMA.
10040 @end deffn
10041
10042 @section Intel Architecture
10043
10044 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10045 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10046 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10047 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10048 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10049 @itemize
10050 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10051 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10052 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10053 @end itemize
10054
10055 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10056 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10057 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10058
10059 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10060 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10061 @end deffn
10062
10063 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10064 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10065 @end deffn
10066
10067 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10068 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10072 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10073 @end deffn
10074
10075 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10076 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10077 @end deffn
10078
10079 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10080 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10081 @end deffn
10082
10083 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10084
10085 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10086 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10087
10088 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10089 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10090 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10091 @end deffn
10092 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10093 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10094
10095 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10096
10097 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10098 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10099 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10100 @end deffn
10101
10102 @subsection Registers commands
10103 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10104 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10105 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10106
10107 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10108
10109 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10110 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10111 and "timer" groups.
10112
10113 @emph{example:}
10114 @example
10115 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10116 @end example
10117
10118 @end deffn
10119
10120 @section RISC-V Architecture
10121
10122 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10123 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10124 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10125 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10126 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10127 implement version 0.11.
10128
10129 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10130
10131 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10132 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10133 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10134
10135 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10136
10137 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10138 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10139 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10140
10141 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10142 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10143 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10144 CSRs.
10145 @end deffn
10146
10147 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10148 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10149 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10150 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10151 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10152 This command must be executed before `init`.
10153 @end deffn
10154
10155 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10156 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10157 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10158 @end deffn
10159
10160 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10161 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10162 deasserted.
10163 @end deffn
10164
10165 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10166 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10167 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10168 @end deffn
10169
10170 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10171 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10172 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10173 on physical memory.
10174 @end deffn
10175
10176 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10177 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10178 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10179 performed on physical memory.
10180 @end deffn
10181
10182 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10183 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10184 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10185 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10186 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10187 race condition problem in your code.
10188
10189 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10190 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10191 @end deffn
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10194 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10195 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10196 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10197 values.
10198
10199 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10200 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10201 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10205 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10206 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10207 @end deffn
10208
10209 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10210 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10211 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10212 @end deffn
10213
10214 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10215 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10216 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10217 @end deffn
10218
10219 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10220 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10221 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10222 @end deffn
10223
10224 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10225
10226 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10227 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10228 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10229 @example
10230 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10231 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10232 @end example
10233
10234 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10235 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10236 @end deffn
10237
10238 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10239 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10240 @end deffn
10241
10242 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10243
10244 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10245 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10246
10247 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10248 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10252 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10253 @end deffn
10254
10255 @section ARC Architecture
10256 @cindex ARC
10257
10258 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10259 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10260 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10261 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10262 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10263 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10264 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10265 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10266 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10267 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10268 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10269 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10270 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10271 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10272 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10273
10274
10275 @subsection General ARC commands
10276
10277 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10278
10279 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10280 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10281 arguments:
10282
10283 @itemize @bullet
10284
10285 @item @code{-name} name
10286 @*Name of a register.
10287
10288 @item @code{-num} number
10289 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10290
10291 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10292 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10293
10294 @end itemize
10295
10296 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10297
10298 @itemize @bullet
10299
10300 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10301 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10302 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10303 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10304 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10305 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10306
10307 @item @code{-core}
10308 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10309 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10310 spaces.
10311
10312 @item @code{-bcr}
10313 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10314 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10315 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10316 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10317 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10318
10319 @item @code{-type} type_name
10320 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10321 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10322
10323 @item @code{-g}
10324 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10325 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10326 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10327 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10328 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10329
10330 @end itemize
10331
10332 @end deffn
10333
10334 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10335 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10336 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10337 @end deffn
10338
10339 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10340 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10341 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10342 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10343 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10344 startbit endbit}.
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10348 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10349 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10350 @end deffn
10351
10352 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10353 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10354 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10355 @end deffn
10356
10357 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10358
10359 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10360 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10361 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10362 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10363
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10367 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10368 registers.
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10372 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10373 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10374 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10375
10376 @end deffn
10377
10378 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10379 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10380 registers.
10381 @end deffn
10382
10383 @section STM8 Architecture
10384 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10385 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10386
10387 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10388 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10389
10390 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10391 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10392 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10393 @cindex tracing
10394 @cindex libdcc
10395 @cindex DCC
10396 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10397 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10398 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10399 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10400
10401 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10402 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10403 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10404 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10405 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10406 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10407
10408 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10409 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10410 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10411 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10412 The target being debugged may
10413 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10414 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10415 each supported by a command:
10416
10417 @itemize
10418 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10419 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10420 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10421 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10422
10423 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10424 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10425 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10426
10427 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10428 and then displayed at any time.
10429 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10430
10431 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10432 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10433 @end itemize
10434
10435 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10436 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10437 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10438 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10439 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10440 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10441 does the same thing.
10442
10443 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10444 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10445 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10446 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10447 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10448
10449 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10450 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10451 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10452 @end deffn
10453
10454 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10455 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10456 in the order they triggered.
10457 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10458 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10459 history records.
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10463 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10464 they have been triggered.
10465 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10466 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10467 and associates it with that identifier.
10468
10469 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10470 are not related except by this command.
10471 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10472 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10473 @end deffn
10474
10475
10476 @node JTAG Commands
10477 @chapter JTAG Commands
10478 @cindex JTAG Commands
10479 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10480 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10481 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10482 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10483 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10484
10485 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10486 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10487
10488 @itemize @bullet
10489 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10490 devices such as a CPUs.
10491 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10492 standard state machine (in parallel)
10493 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10494 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10495 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10496 while the reading previous ones.
10497 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10498 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10499 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10500 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10501 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10502 registers.
10503 @end itemize
10504
10505 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10506
10507 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10508 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10509 the order of TAP state transitions.
10510 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10511 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10512 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10513 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10514 these commands are not available.
10515
10516 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10517 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10518 that specify the entire register.
10519 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10520 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10521 The return value holds the original value of each
10522 of those fields.
10523
10524 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10525 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10526 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10527 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10528 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10529
10530 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10531 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10532
10533 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10534 in that state.
10535 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10536 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10537 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10538
10539 @quotation Warning
10540 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10541 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10542 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10543 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10544 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10545 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10546 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10547 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10548 @end quotation
10549 @end deffn
10550
10551 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10552 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10553 This may be used for performance tuning.
10554
10555 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10556 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10557 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10558 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10559 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10560 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10561 @end deffn
10562
10563 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10564 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10565 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10566 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10567 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10568 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10569
10570 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10571 in that state.
10572 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10573 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10574 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10575
10576 @quotation Note
10577 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10578 register values, unlike data register values.
10579 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10580 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10581 @end quotation
10582 @end deffn
10583
10584 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10585 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10586 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10587 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10588 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10589 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10590 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10591 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10592 The final state must also be stable.
10593 @end deffn
10594
10595 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10596 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10597 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10598 Instructions often need some time
10599 to execute before they take effect.
10600 @end deffn
10601
10602 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10603 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10604
10605 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10606 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10607 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10608 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10609 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10610 @end deffn
10611
10612 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10613 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10614 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10615 must also be enabled.
10616 Default is enabled.
10617 @end deffn
10618
10619 @section TAP state names
10620 @cindex TAP state names
10621
10622 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10623 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10624 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10625 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10626
10627 @itemize @bullet
10628 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10629 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10630 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10631 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10632 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10633 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10634 through the data register
10635 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10636 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10637 for update or more shifting
10638 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10639 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10640 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10641 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10642 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10643 through the instruction register
10644 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10645 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10646 for update or more shifting
10647 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10648 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10649 @end itemize
10650
10651 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10652 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10653 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10654 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10655
10656 @itemize @bullet
10657 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10658 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10659 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10660 may not be as expected.
10661 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10662 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10663 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10664 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10665 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10666 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10667 @end itemize
10668
10669 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10670 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10671
10672 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10673 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10674 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10675 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10676
10677 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10678 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10679 @cindex SVF
10680
10681 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10682 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10683 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10684 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10685
10686 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10687 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10688 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10689 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10690
10691 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10692 affect their semantics.
10693
10694 Command options:
10695 @itemize @minus
10696 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10697 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10698 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10699 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10700 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10701 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10702 on the real interface;
10703 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10704 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10705 errors.
10706 @end itemize
10707 @end deffn
10708
10709 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10710 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10711 @cindex XSVF
10712
10713 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10714 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10715 Xilinx devices.
10716 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10717 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10718
10719 @quotation Important
10720 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10721 @end quotation
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10724 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10725 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10726 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10727 that TAP.
10728 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10729 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10730 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10731 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10732 @end deffn
10733
10734 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10735 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10736 after building the software.
10737 You may find them useful:
10738
10739 @itemize
10740 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10741 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10742 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10743 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10744 @end itemize
10745
10746 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10747 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10748 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10749 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10750 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10751 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10752 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10753
10754
10755 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10756 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10757 @cindex IPDBG
10758
10759 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10760 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10761 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10762 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10763 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10764 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10765
10766 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10767 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10768
10769 Command options:
10770 @itemize @bullet
10771 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10772 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10773 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10774 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10775 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10776 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10777 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10778 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10779 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10780 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10781 shift data through vir can be configured.
10782 @end itemize
10783 @end deffn
10784
10785 Examples:
10786 @example
10787 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10788 @end example
10789 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10790 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10791
10792 @example
10793 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10794 @end example
10795 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10796 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10797
10798 @node Utility Commands
10799 @chapter Utility Commands
10800 @cindex Utility Commands
10801
10802 @section RAM testing
10803 @cindex RAM testing
10804
10805 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10806 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10807 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10808 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10809 hardware problems.
10810
10811 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10812 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10813 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10814 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10815
10816 Load the memory testing functions with
10817
10818 @example
10819 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10820 @end example
10821
10822 to get access to the following facilities:
10823
10824 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10825 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10826 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10827 @end deffn
10828
10829 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10830 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10831 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10832 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10833 @end deffn
10834
10835 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10836 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10837 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10838 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10839 @end deffn
10840
10841 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10842 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10843 @end deffn
10844
10845 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10846 @cindex Firmware recovery
10847
10848 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10849 devices recovery with JTAG.
10850
10851 For quickstart instructions run:
10852 @example
10853 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10854 @end example
10855
10856 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10857 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10858 @cindex GDB
10859 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10860 to debug remote targets.
10861 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10862
10863 @itemize
10864 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10865 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10866 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10867 as shown in this chapter.
10868 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10869 that also will probably need to be configured.
10870 @end itemize
10871
10872 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10873 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10874 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10875 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10876 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10877 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10878
10879 @section Connecting to GDB
10880 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10881 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10882 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10883 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10884 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10885
10886 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10887
10888 @enumerate
10889 @item
10890 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10891 @example
10892 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10893 @end example
10894 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10895
10896 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10897 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10898 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10899
10900 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10901 remote command above that becomes:
10902 @example
10903 tar ext :3333
10904 @end example
10905
10906 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10907 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10908 available through the command:
10909 @example
10910 target remote localhost:3333
10911 @end example
10912
10913 @item
10914 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10915 @example
10916 target extended-remote | \
10917 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10918 @end example
10919 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10920 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10921 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10922 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10923 @end enumerate
10924
10925 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10926 GDB command line.
10927
10928 @section Sample GDB session startup
10929
10930 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10931 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10932 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10933 small ARM program.
10934 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10935 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10936
10937 @example
10938 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10939 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10940 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10941 ...
10942 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10943 ...
10944 (gdb) load
10945 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10946 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10947 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10948 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10949 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10950 (gdb) continue
10951 Continuing.
10952 ...
10953 @end example
10954
10955 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10956 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10957 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10958 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10959
10960 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10961
10962 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10963 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10964 packet size and the device's memory map.
10965 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10966 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10967 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10968
10969 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10970 You may need to set those up by hand.
10971 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10972 something like:
10973
10974 @example
10975 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10976 @end example
10977
10978 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10979
10980 @example
10981 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10982 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10983 @end example
10984
10985 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10986 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10987 do not have such restrictions.
10988
10989 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10990 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10991 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10992 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10993
10994 @section Programming using GDB
10995 @cindex Programming using GDB
10996 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10997
10998 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10999 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11000 @example
11001 gdb_memory_map disable
11002 @end example
11003 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11004 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11005 working area.
11006
11007 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11008 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11009 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11010 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11011
11012 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11013 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11014
11015 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11016 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11017 @example
11018 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11019 @end example
11020
11021 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11022 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11023
11024 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11025 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11026 will be used.
11027
11028 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11029 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11030 @example
11031 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11032 @end example
11033 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11034
11035 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11036 can be used.
11037
11038 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11039 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11040 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11041
11042 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11043 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11044 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11045
11046 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11047 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11048 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11049 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11050 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11051 without any intrusion of the target process.
11052
11053 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11054 Place following command after target configuration:
11055 @example
11056 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11057 @end example
11058
11059 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11060 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11061 @example
11062 gdb_memory_map disable
11063 @end example
11064
11065 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11066 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11067 @example
11068 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11069 @end example
11070
11071 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11072 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11073
11074 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11075 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11076 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11077 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11078
11079 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11080 previously shown variables.
11081
11082 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11083 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11084 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11085 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11086 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11087
11088 @section RTOS Support
11089 @cindex RTOS Support
11090 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11091
11092 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11093 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11094
11095 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11096 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11097 GDB commands.
11098
11099 @* An example setup is below:
11100
11101 @example
11102 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11103 @end example
11104
11105 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11106
11107 Currently supported rtos's include:
11108 @itemize @bullet
11109 @item @option{eCos}
11110 @item @option{ThreadX}
11111 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11112 @item @option{linux}
11113 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11114 @item @option{embKernel}
11115 @item @option{mqx}
11116 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11117 @item @option{nuttx}
11118 @item @option{RIOT}
11119 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11120 @item @option{Zephyr}
11121 @end itemize
11122
11123 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11124 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11125
11126 @table @code
11127 @item eCos symbols
11128 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11129 @item ThreadX symbols
11130 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11131 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11132 @raggedright
11133 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11134 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11135 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11136 @end raggedright
11137 @item linux symbols
11138 init_task.
11139 @item ChibiOS symbols
11140 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11141 @item embKernel symbols
11142 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11143 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11144 @item mqx symbols
11145 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11146 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11147 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11148 @item nuttx symbols
11149 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11150 @item RIOT symbols
11151 @raggedright
11152 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11153 _tcb_name_offset.
11154 @end raggedright
11155 @item Zephyr symbols
11156 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11157 @end table
11158
11159 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11160 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11161
11162 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11163 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11164
11165 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11166 along with the project:
11167
11168 @table @code
11169 @item FreeRTOS
11170 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11171 @item uC/OS-III
11172 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11173 @end table
11174
11175 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11176 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11177 @cindex SMP
11178 @cindex RTOS
11179 @cindex hwthread
11180 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11181 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11182 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11183 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11184 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11185 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11186 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11187 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11188 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11189
11190 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11191 @quotation Note
11192 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11193 @end quotation
11194
11195 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11196 @itemize @bullet
11197 @item j - smp status request
11198 @item J - smp set request
11199 @end itemize
11200
11201 OpenOCD implements :
11202 @itemize @bullet
11203 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11204 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11205 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11206 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11207 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11208 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11209 @end itemize
11210
11211 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11212 @itemize @bullet
11213 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11214 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11215 @example
11216 set $_core 1
11217 #Jc01 packet is sent
11218 print $_core
11219 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11220 @end example
11221
11222 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11223 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11224
11225 @example
11226 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11227 define toggle0
11228 maint packet Jc0
11229 continue
11230 main packet Jc-1
11231 end
11232 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11233 define toggle1
11234 maint packet Jc1
11235 continue
11236 main packet Jc-1
11237 end
11238 @end example
11239 @end itemize
11240
11241 @node Tcl Scripting API
11242 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11243 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11244 @cindex Tcl scripts
11245 @section API rules
11246
11247 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11248 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11249 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11250
11251 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11252 pair list and lists.
11253
11254 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11255 list.
11256
11257 @example
11258 > set foo(me) Duane
11259 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11260 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11261 > set foo(duck) Donald
11262 @end example
11263
11264 If one does this:
11265
11266 @example
11267 > set foo
11268 @end example
11269
11270 The result is:
11271
11272 @example
11273 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11274 @end example
11275
11276 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11277
11278 @verbatim
11279 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11280 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11281 }
11282 @end verbatim
11283
11284 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11285 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11286
11287 @section Internal low-level Commands
11288
11289 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11290 invoke directly.
11291
11292 @itemize @bullet
11293 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11294
11295 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11296 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11297
11298 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11299 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11300
11301 Return information about the flash banks
11302
11303 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11304
11305 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11306 its execution. Example:
11307
11308 @example
11309 > capture "reset init"
11310 @end example
11311
11312 @end itemize
11313
11314 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11315 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11316 called "flash_banks".
11317
11318 @section Tcl RPC server
11319 @cindex RPC
11320
11321 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11322 commands and receive the results.
11323
11324 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11325 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11326 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11327 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11328 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11329
11330 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11331 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11332 @command{capture} command.
11333
11334 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11335
11336 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11337 @cindex RPC Notifications
11338
11339 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11340 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11341
11342 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11343 in the following format.
11344
11345 @verbatim
11346 type target_event event [event-name]
11347 type target_state state [state-name]
11348 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11349 @end verbatim
11350
11351 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11352 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11353 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11354 Defaults to off.
11355
11356 @end deffn
11357
11358 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11359 @cindex RPC trace output
11360
11361 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11362 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11363
11364 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11365
11366 @verbatim
11367 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11368 @end verbatim
11369
11370 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11371 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11372 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11373 Defaults to off.
11374
11375 See an example application here:
11376 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11377
11378 @end deffn
11379
11380 @node FAQ
11381 @chapter FAQ
11382 @cindex faq
11383 @enumerate
11384 @anchor{faqrtck}
11385 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11386 @cindex RTCK
11387 @cindex adaptive clocking
11388 @*
11389
11390 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11391 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11392 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11393 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11394
11395 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11396 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11397 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11398 @enumerate
11399 @item
11400 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11401 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11402 @item
11403 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11404 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11405 @end enumerate
11406
11407 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11408 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11409 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11410 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11411 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11412 power).
11413
11414 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11415 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11416 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11417 ARM926 scenario).
11418 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11419 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11420 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11421
11422 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11423 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11424 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11425 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11426
11427 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11428
11429 In order to make use of this,
11430 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11431 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11432
11433 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11434 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11435 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11436 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11437 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11438
11439 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11440 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11441 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11442 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11443
11444 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11445 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11446 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11447 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11448 with a CPLD.
11449 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11450 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11451 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11452 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11453 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11454 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11455
11456 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11457
11458 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11459
11460 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11461 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11462 depending on the chips on your board.
11463 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11464 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11465 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11466
11467 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11468 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11469 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11470
11471 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11472 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11473 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11474 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11475
11476 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11477 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11478 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11479 this way.
11480
11481 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11482 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11483 clock rate.
11484 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11485 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11486 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11487
11488 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11489
11490 @example
11491 # Example: 1.234MHz
11492 adapter speed 1234
11493 @end example
11494
11495
11496 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11497
11498 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11499 around Windows filenames.
11500
11501 @example
11502 > echo \a
11503
11504 > echo @{\a@}
11505 \a
11506 > echo "\a"
11507
11508 >
11509 @end example
11510
11511
11512 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11513
11514 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11515 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11516 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11517
11518 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11519 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11520 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11521
11522 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11523 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11524 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11525
11526 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11527
11528 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11529 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11530 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11531 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11532
11533 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11534 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11535 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11536
11537 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11538 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11539
11540 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11541 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11542 memory read caused data abort".
11543
11544 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11545 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11546 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11547 be done, feel free to add this here.
11548
11549 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11550 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11551 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11552 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11553 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11554 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11555 gracefully stops.
11556
11557 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11558 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11559 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11560
11561 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11562 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11563 bytes. Painful...
11564
11565
11566 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11567 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11568
11569 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11570 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11571 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11572 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11573 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11574 reset, everything else should work fine.
11575
11576 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11577 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11578 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11579 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11580
11581 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11582 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11583 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11584 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11585
11586 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11587
11588 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11589 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11590 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11591
11592 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11593 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11594
11595 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11596 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11597 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11598 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11599 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11600 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11601 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11602 clock frequency?
11603
11604 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11605 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11606 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11607 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11608 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11609
11610 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11611
11612 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11613 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11614 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11615 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11616 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11617 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11618 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11619
11620 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11621
11622 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11623 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11624 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11625 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11626
11627 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11628 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11629 particular order?
11630
11631 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11632 the same order used by the hardware.
11633
11634 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11635 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11636 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11637 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11638 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11639 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11640
11641 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11642 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11643 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11644 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11645
11646 @itemize @bullet
11647 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11648 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11649 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11650 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11651 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11652 @end itemize
11653
11654 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11655
11656 @itemize @bullet
11657 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11658 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11659 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11660 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11661 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11662 @end itemize
11663
11664
11665 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11666 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11667 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11668
11669 TODO.
11670
11671 @end enumerate
11672
11673 @node Tcl Crash Course
11674 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11675 @cindex Tcl
11676
11677 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11678 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11679 how the Tcl scripts work.
11680
11681 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11682 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11683 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11684 OpenOCD.
11685
11686 @section Tcl Rule #1
11687 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11688 @enumerate
11689 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11690 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11691 @end enumerate
11692
11693 The Tcl equal is this:
11694
11695 @enumerate
11696 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11697 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11698 @end enumerate
11699
11700 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11701 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11702
11703 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11704 There is a second pair of rules.
11705 @enumerate
11706 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11707 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11708 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11709 in Tcl.
11710 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11711 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11712 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11713 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11714 @end enumerate
11715
11716 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11717 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11718 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11719 Everything is a string}
11720
11721 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11722 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11723 difference is subtle.
11724 @enumerate
11725 @item Parse Time
11726 @item Evaluation Time
11727 @end enumerate
11728
11729 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11730 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11731 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11732
11733 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11734 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11735 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11736 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11737
11738 @itemize @bullet
11739 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11740 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11741 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11742 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11743 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11744 @example
11745 # bash example
11746 X=`date`
11747 echo "The Date is: $X"
11748 # Tcl example
11749 set X [date]
11750 puts "The Date is: $X"
11751 @end example
11752 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11753 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11754 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11755 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11756 is a string}
11757 @example
11758 set x "Dinner"
11759 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11760 @end example
11761 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11762 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11763 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11764 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11765 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11766 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11767 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11768 @end itemize
11769
11770 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11771
11772 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11773
11774 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11775
11776 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11777 the normal way.
11778
11779 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11780 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11781 line is immediately executed.
11782
11783 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11784 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11785
11786 @subsection Command Execution
11787
11788 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11789 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11790 control flow operators.
11791
11792 Commands are executed like this:
11793
11794 @enumerate
11795 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11796 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11797 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11798 @end enumerate
11799
11800 It sort of works like this:
11801 @example
11802 for(;;)@{
11803 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11804
11805 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11806
11807 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11808 @}
11809 @end example
11810
11811 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11812 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11813 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11814 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11815 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11816 ``LookupCommand()''
11817
11818 @subsection The FOR command
11819
11820 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11821 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11822 command just like any other command.
11823
11824 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11825 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11826 are:
11827
11828 @enumerate 0
11829 @item The ascii text 'for'
11830 @item The start text
11831 @item The test expression
11832 @item The next text
11833 @item The body text
11834 @end enumerate
11835
11836 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11837 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11838 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11839 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11840
11841 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11842 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11843
11844 @example
11845 int
11846 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11847 int *argc,
11848 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11849 @end example
11850
11851 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11852 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11853 still operates in the same basic way.
11854
11855 @subsection FOR command implementation
11856
11857 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11858 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11859
11860 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11861
11862 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11863
11864 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11865 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11866 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11867
11868 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11869 expression and returns a value.
11870
11871 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11872 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11873 @example
11874 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11875
11876 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11877
11878 int
11879 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11880 int argc,
11881 char **argv )
11882 @{
11883 if( argc != 5 )@{
11884 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11885 return ERROR;
11886 @}
11887
11888 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11889
11890 // Execute the start statement.
11891 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11892
11893 // Top of loop test
11894 for(;;)@{
11895 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11896 if( i == 0 )
11897 break;
11898
11899 // Execute the body
11900 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11901
11902 // Execute the LOOP part
11903 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11904 @}
11905
11906 // Return no error
11907 SetResult( interp, "" );
11908 return SUCCESS;
11909 @}
11910 @end example
11911
11912 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11913 in the same basic way.
11914
11915 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11916
11917 @subsection source and find commands
11918 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11919 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11920 @*Remember the parsing rules
11921 @enumerate
11922 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11923 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11924 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11925 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11926 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11927 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11928 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11929 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11930 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11931 @end enumerate
11932 @subsection format command
11933 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11934 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11935 @b{sprintf()}.
11936 @b{Example}
11937 @example
11938 set x 6
11939 set y 7
11940 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11941 @end example
11942 @enumerate
11943 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11944 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11945 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11946 @* Refer to Rule #1
11947 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11948 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11949 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11950 @end enumerate
11951 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11952 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11953 @example
11954 #1 Good
11955 proc someproc @{@} @{
11956 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11957 @}
11958 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11959 #2 Good - no variables
11960 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11961 #3 Good Curly Braces
11962 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11963 puts "Time: [date]"
11964 @}
11965 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11966 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11967 @end example
11968 @enumerate
11969 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11970 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11971 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11972 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11973 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11974 command.
11975 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11976 @*There are 4 examples:
11977 @enumerate
11978 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11979 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11980 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11981 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11982 @end enumerate
11983
11984 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11985 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11986 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11987
11988 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11989 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11990 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11991 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11992 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11993 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11994 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11995 @end enumerate
11996 @subsection Global Variables
11997 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11998 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11999 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12000 @example
12001 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12002 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12003 global x #Global variable X
12004 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12005 @}
12006 @end example
12007 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12008 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12009 @example
12010 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12011 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12012 # Create var name
12013 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12014 # Make it a global
12015 global $vn
12016 # Set it.
12017 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12018 @}
12019 @end example
12020 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12021 @example
12022 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12023 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12024 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12025 @}
12026 @end example
12027
12028 @node License
12029 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12030 @include fdl.texi
12031
12032 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12033 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12034 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12035 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12036 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12037 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12038
12039 @printindex cp
12040
12041 @node Command and Driver Index
12042 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12043 @printindex fn
12044
12045 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)